/* GTK - The GIMP Toolkit * Copyright (C) 1995-1997 Peter Mattis, Spencer Kimball and Josh MacDonald * * This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either * version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version. * * This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU * Lesser General Public License for more details. * * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public * License along with this library; if not, write to the * Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, * Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */ /* * Modified by the GTK+ Team and others 1997-2000. See the AUTHORS * file for a list of people on the GTK+ Team. See the ChangeLog * files for a list of changes. These files are distributed with * GTK+ at ftp://ftp.gtk.org/pub/gtk/. */ #include "config.h" #include #include #include #include #include #include #include "gtkcontainer.h" #include "gtkaccelmap.h" #include "gtkclipboard.h" #include "gtkiconfactory.h" #include "gtkintl.h" #include "gtkmainprivate.h" #include "gtkmarshalers.h" #include "gtkrc.h" #include "gtkselectionprivate.h" #include "gtksettingsprivate.h" #include "gtksizegroup-private.h" #include "gtkwidget.h" #include "gtkwidgetprivate.h" #include "gtkwindowprivate.h" #include "gtkbindings.h" #include "gtkprivate.h" #include "gtkaccessible.h" #include "gtktooltip.h" #include "gtkinvisible.h" #include "gtkbuildable.h" #include "gtkbuilderprivate.h" #include "gtksizerequest.h" #include "gtkstylecontextprivate.h" #include "gtksymboliccolor.h" #include "gtkcssprovider.h" #include "gtkanimationdescription.h" #include "gtkmodifierstyle.h" #include "gtkversion.h" #include "gtkdebug.h" #include "gtkplug.h" #include "gtktypebuiltins.h" /** * SECTION:gtkwidget * @Short_description: Base class for all widgets * @Title: GtkWidget * * GtkWidget is the base class all widgets in GTK+ derive from. It manages the * widget lifecycle, states and style. * * * Height-for-width Geometry Management * * GTK+ uses a height-for-width (and width-for-height) geometry management * system. Height-for-width means that a widget can change how much * vertical space it needs, depending on the amount of horizontal space * that it is given (and similar for width-for-height). The most common * example is a label that reflows to fill up the available width, wraps * to fewer lines, and therefore needs less height. * * Height-for-width geometry management is implemented in GTK+ by way * of five virtual methods: * * #GtkWidgetClass.get_request_mode() * #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_width() * #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_height() * #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_height_for_width() * #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_width_for_height() * * * There are some important things to keep in mind when implementing * height-for-width and when using it in container implementations. * * The geometry management system will query a widget hierarchy in * only one orientation at a time. When widgets are initially queried * for their minimum sizes it is generally done in two initial passes * in the #GtkSizeRequestMode chosen by the toplevel. * * For example, when queried in the normal * %GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_HEIGHT_FOR_WIDTH mode: * First, the default minimum and natural width for each widget * in the interface will be computed using gtk_widget_get_preferred_width(). * Because the preferred widths for each container depend on the preferred * widths of their children, this information propagates up the hierarchy, * and finally a minimum and natural width is determined for the entire * toplevel. Next, the toplevel will use the minimum width to query for the * minimum height contextual to that width using * gtk_widget_get_preferred_height_for_width(), which will also be a highly * recursive operation. The minimum height for the minimum width is normally * used to set the minimum size constraint on the toplevel * (unless gtk_window_set_geometry_hints() is explicitly used instead). * * After the toplevel window has initially requested its size in both * dimensions it can go on to allocate itself a reasonable size (or a size * previously specified with gtk_window_set_default_size()). During the * recursive allocation process it's important to note that request cycles * will be recursively executed while container widgets allocate their children. * Each container widget, once allocated a size, will go on to first share the * space in one orientation among its children and then request each child's * height for its target allocated width or its width for allocated height, * depending. In this way a #GtkWidget will typically be requested its size * a number of times before actually being allocated a size. The size a * widget is finally allocated can of course differ from the size it has * requested. For this reason, #GtkWidget caches a small number of results * to avoid re-querying for the same sizes in one allocation cycle. * * See GtkContainer's * geometry management section * to learn more about how height-for-width allocations are performed * by container widgets. * * If a widget does move content around to intelligently use up the * allocated size then it must support the request in both * #GtkSizeRequestModes even if the widget in question only * trades sizes in a single orientation. * * For instance, a #GtkLabel that does height-for-width word wrapping * will not expect to have #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_height() called * because that call is specific to a width-for-height request. In this * case the label must return the height required for its own minimum * possible width. By following this rule any widget that handles * height-for-width or width-for-height requests will always be allocated * at least enough space to fit its own content. * * Here are some examples of how a %GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_HEIGHT_FOR_WIDTH widget * generally deals with width-for-height requests, for #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_height() * it will do: * get_preferred_width (widget, &min_width, NULL); * GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->get_preferred_height_for_width (widget, min_width, * min_height, nat_height); * } * else * { * ... some widgets do both. For instance, if a GtkLabel is rotated to 90 degrees * it will return the minimum and natural height for the rotated label here. * } * } * ]]> * * And in #GtkWidgetClass.get_preferred_width_for_height() it will simply return * the minimum and natural width: * * get_preferred_width (widget, min_width, nat_width); * } * else * { * ... again if a widget is sometimes operating in width-for-height mode * (like a rotated GtkLabel) it can go ahead and do its real width for * height calculation here. * } * } * ]]> * * Often a widget needs to get its own request during size request or * allocation. For example, when computing height it may need to also * compute width. Or when deciding how to use an allocation, the widget * may need to know its natural size. In these cases, the widget should * be careful to call its virtual methods directly, like this: * * Widget calling its own size request method. * * GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS(widget)->get_preferred_width (widget), * &min, &natural); * * * * It will not work to use the wrapper functions, such as * gtk_widget_get_preferred_width() inside your own size request * implementation. These return a request adjusted by #GtkSizeGroup * and by the #GtkWidgetClass.adjust_size_request() virtual method. If a * widget used the wrappers inside its virtual method implementations, * then the adjustments (such as widget margins) would be applied * twice. GTK+ therefore does not allow this and will warn if you try * to do it. * * Of course if you are getting the size request for * another widget, such as a child of a * container, you must use the wrapper APIs. * Otherwise, you would not properly consider widget margins, * #GtkSizeGroup, and so forth. * * * * Style Properties * * GtkWidget introduces style * properties - these are basically object properties that are stored * not on the object, but in the style object associated to the widget. Style * properties are set in resource files. * This mechanism is used for configuring such things as the location of the * scrollbar arrows through the theme, giving theme authors more control over the * look of applications without the need to write a theme engine in C. * * * Use gtk_widget_class_install_style_property() to install style properties for * a widget class, gtk_widget_class_find_style_property() or * gtk_widget_class_list_style_properties() to get information about existing * style properties and gtk_widget_style_get_property(), gtk_widget_style_get() or * gtk_widget_style_get_valist() to obtain the value of a style property. * * * * GtkWidget as GtkBuildable * * The GtkWidget implementation of the GtkBuildable interface supports a * custom <accelerator> element, which has attributes named key, * modifiers and signal and allows to specify accelerators. * * * A UI definition fragment specifying an accelerator * * * * ]]> * * * In addition to accelerators, GtkWidget also support a * custom <accessible> element, which supports actions and relations. * Properties on the accessible implementation of an object can be set by accessing the * internal child "accessible" of a GtkWidget. * * * A UI definition fragment specifying an accessible * * I am a Label for a Button * * * * Click the button. * * * * * Clickable Button * * * * ]]> * * * Finally, GtkWidget allows style information such as style classes to * be associated with widgets, using the custom <style> element: * * A UI definition fragment specifying an style class * * * * ]]> * * * */ /* Add flags here that should not be propagated to children. By default, * all flags will be set on children (think prelight or active), but we * might want to not do this for some. */ #define GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DONT_PROPAGATE (GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED) #define GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_PROPAGATE (~GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DONT_PROPAGATE) #define WIDGET_CLASS(w) GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (w) #define INIT_PATH_SIZE (512) struct _GtkWidgetPrivate { /* The state of the widget. There are actually only * 5 widget states (defined in "gtkenums.h") * so 3 bits. */ guint state_flags : 6; guint direction : 2; guint in_destruction : 1; guint toplevel : 1; guint anchored : 1; guint composite_child : 1; guint no_window : 1; guint realized : 1; guint mapped : 1; guint visible : 1; guint sensitive : 1; guint can_focus : 1; guint has_focus : 1; guint can_default : 1; guint has_default : 1; guint receives_default : 1; guint has_grab : 1; guint shadowed : 1; guint rc_style : 1; guint style_update_pending : 1; guint app_paintable : 1; guint double_buffered : 1; guint redraw_on_alloc : 1; guint no_show_all : 1; guint child_visible : 1; guint multidevice : 1; guint has_shape_mask : 1; guint in_reparent : 1; /* Queue-resize related flags */ guint resize_pending : 1; guint alloc_needed : 1; guint width_request_needed : 1; guint height_request_needed : 1; /* Expand-related flags */ guint need_compute_expand : 1; /* Need to recompute computed_[hv]_expand */ guint computed_hexpand : 1; /* computed results (composite of child flags) */ guint computed_vexpand : 1; guint hexpand : 1; /* application-forced expand */ guint vexpand : 1; guint hexpand_set : 1; /* whether to use application-forced */ guint vexpand_set : 1; /* instead of computing from children */ /* SizeGroup related flags */ guint sizegroup_visited : 1; guint sizegroup_bumping : 1; guint have_size_groups : 1; /* The widget's name. If the widget does not have a name * (the name is NULL), then its name (as returned by * "gtk_widget_get_name") is its class's name. * Among other things, the widget name is used to determine * the style to use for a widget. */ gchar *name; /* The style for the widget. The style contains the * colors the widget should be drawn in for each state * along with graphics contexts used to draw with and * the font to use for text. */ GtkStyle *style; GtkStyleContext *context; /* Widget's path for styling */ GtkWidgetPath *path; /* The widget's allocated size */ GtkAllocation allocation; /* The widget's requested sizes */ SizeRequestCache requests; /* The widget's window or its parent window if it does * not have a window. (Which will be indicated by the * GTK_NO_WINDOW flag being set). */ GdkWindow *window; /* The widget's parent */ GtkWidget *parent; #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG /* Number of gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants () */ guint verifying_invariants_count; #endif /* G_ENABLE_DEBUG */ }; enum { DESTROY, SHOW, HIDE, MAP, UNMAP, REALIZE, UNREALIZE, SIZE_ALLOCATE, STATE_FLAGS_CHANGED, STATE_CHANGED, PARENT_SET, HIERARCHY_CHANGED, STYLE_SET, DIRECTION_CHANGED, GRAB_NOTIFY, CHILD_NOTIFY, DRAW, MNEMONIC_ACTIVATE, GRAB_FOCUS, FOCUS, MOVE_FOCUS, KEYNAV_FAILED, EVENT, EVENT_AFTER, BUTTON_PRESS_EVENT, BUTTON_RELEASE_EVENT, SCROLL_EVENT, MOTION_NOTIFY_EVENT, DELETE_EVENT, DESTROY_EVENT, KEY_PRESS_EVENT, KEY_RELEASE_EVENT, ENTER_NOTIFY_EVENT, LEAVE_NOTIFY_EVENT, CONFIGURE_EVENT, FOCUS_IN_EVENT, FOCUS_OUT_EVENT, MAP_EVENT, UNMAP_EVENT, PROPERTY_NOTIFY_EVENT, SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT, SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT, SELECTION_NOTIFY_EVENT, SELECTION_GET, SELECTION_RECEIVED, PROXIMITY_IN_EVENT, PROXIMITY_OUT_EVENT, VISIBILITY_NOTIFY_EVENT, WINDOW_STATE_EVENT, DAMAGE_EVENT, GRAB_BROKEN_EVENT, DRAG_BEGIN, DRAG_END, DRAG_DATA_DELETE, DRAG_LEAVE, DRAG_MOTION, DRAG_DROP, DRAG_DATA_GET, DRAG_DATA_RECEIVED, POPUP_MENU, SHOW_HELP, ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED, SCREEN_CHANGED, CAN_ACTIVATE_ACCEL, COMPOSITED_CHANGED, QUERY_TOOLTIP, DRAG_FAILED, STYLE_UPDATED, LAST_SIGNAL }; enum { PROP_0, PROP_NAME, PROP_PARENT, PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST, PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST, PROP_VISIBLE, PROP_SENSITIVE, PROP_APP_PAINTABLE, PROP_CAN_FOCUS, PROP_HAS_FOCUS, PROP_IS_FOCUS, PROP_CAN_DEFAULT, PROP_HAS_DEFAULT, PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT, PROP_COMPOSITE_CHILD, PROP_STYLE, PROP_EVENTS, PROP_NO_SHOW_ALL, PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP, PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP, PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT, PROP_WINDOW, PROP_DOUBLE_BUFFERED, PROP_HALIGN, PROP_VALIGN, PROP_MARGIN_LEFT, PROP_MARGIN_RIGHT, PROP_MARGIN_TOP, PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM, PROP_MARGIN, PROP_HEXPAND, PROP_VEXPAND, PROP_HEXPAND_SET, PROP_VEXPAND_SET, PROP_EXPAND }; typedef struct _GtkStateData GtkStateData; enum { STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE, STATE_CHANGE_SET, STATE_CHANGE_UNSET }; struct _GtkStateData { guint flags : 6; guint operation : 2; guint use_forall : 1; }; /* --- prototypes --- */ static void gtk_widget_class_init (GtkWidgetClass *klass); static void gtk_widget_base_class_finalize (GtkWidgetClass *klass); static void gtk_widget_init (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_set_property (GObject *object, guint prop_id, const GValue *value, GParamSpec *pspec); static void gtk_widget_get_property (GObject *object, guint prop_id, GValue *value, GParamSpec *pspec); static void gtk_widget_dispose (GObject *object); static void gtk_widget_real_destroy (GtkWidget *object); static void gtk_widget_finalize (GObject *object); static void gtk_widget_real_show (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_real_hide (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_real_map (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_real_unmap (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_real_realize (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_real_unrealize (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_real_size_allocate (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAllocation *allocation); static void gtk_widget_real_style_set (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStyle *previous_style); static void gtk_widget_real_direction_changed(GtkWidget *widget, GtkTextDirection previous_direction); static void gtk_widget_real_grab_focus (GtkWidget *focus_widget); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_query_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, gint x, gint y, gboolean keyboard_tip, GtkTooltip *tooltip); static void gtk_widget_real_style_updated (GtkWidget *widget); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_show_help (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidgetHelpType help_type); static void gtk_widget_dispatch_child_properties_changed (GtkWidget *object, guint n_pspecs, GParamSpec **pspecs); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_key_press_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventKey *event); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_key_release_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventKey *event); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_focus_in_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventFocus *event); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_focus_out_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventFocus *event); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_focus (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction); static void gtk_widget_real_move_focus (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_keynav_failed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction); #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG static void gtk_widget_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget); #else #define gtk_widget_verify_invariants(widget) #define gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants(widget) #define gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants(widget) #endif static PangoContext* gtk_widget_peek_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_update_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_propagate_state (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateData *data); ; static gint gtk_widget_event_internal (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEvent *event); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_mnemonic_activate (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean group_cycling); static void gtk_widget_real_get_width (GtkWidget *widget, gint *minimum_size, gint *natural_size); static void gtk_widget_real_get_height (GtkWidget *widget, gint *minimum_size, gint *natural_size); static void gtk_widget_real_get_height_for_width (GtkWidget *widget, gint width, gint *minimum_height, gint *natural_height); static void gtk_widget_real_get_width_for_height (GtkWidget *widget, gint height, gint *minimum_width, gint *natural_width); static const GtkWidgetAuxInfo* _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (GtkWidget *widget); static GtkWidgetAuxInfo* gtk_widget_get_aux_info (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean create); static void gtk_widget_aux_info_destroy (GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info); static AtkObject* gtk_widget_real_get_accessible (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_accessible_interface_init (AtkImplementorIface *iface); static AtkObject* gtk_widget_ref_accessible (AtkImplementor *implementor); static void gtk_widget_invalidate_widget_windows (GtkWidget *widget, cairo_region_t *region); static GdkScreen * gtk_widget_get_screen_unchecked (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_queue_shallow_draw (GtkWidget *widget); static gboolean gtk_widget_real_can_activate_accel (GtkWidget *widget, guint signal_id); static void gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean has_tooltip, gboolean force); static void gtk_widget_buildable_interface_init (GtkBuildableIface *iface); static void gtk_widget_buildable_set_name (GtkBuildable *buildable, const gchar *name); static const gchar * gtk_widget_buildable_get_name (GtkBuildable *buildable); static GObject * gtk_widget_buildable_get_internal_child (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, const gchar *childname); static void gtk_widget_buildable_set_buildable_property (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, const gchar *name, const GValue *value); static gboolean gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_start (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, GObject *child, const gchar *tagname, GMarkupParser *parser, gpointer *data); static void gtk_widget_buildable_custom_finished (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, GObject *child, const gchar *tagname, gpointer data); static void gtk_widget_buildable_parser_finished (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder); static GtkSizeRequestMode gtk_widget_real_get_request_mode (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_real_get_width (GtkWidget *widget, gint *minimum_size, gint *natural_size); static void gtk_widget_real_get_height (GtkWidget *widget, gint *minimum_size, gint *natural_size); static void gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query (GtkWidget *widget); static void gtk_widget_real_adjust_size_request (GtkWidget *widget, GtkOrientation orientation, gint *minimum_size, gint *natural_size); static void gtk_widget_real_adjust_size_allocation (GtkWidget *widget, GtkOrientation orientation, gint *minimum_size, gint *natural_size, gint *allocated_pos, gint *allocated_size); static void gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (GtkWidget *widget, gint width, gint height, GtkQueueResizeFlags flags); static void gtk_widget_add_events_internal (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device, gint events); static void gtk_widget_set_device_enabled_internal (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device, gboolean recurse, gboolean enabled); /* --- variables --- */ static gpointer gtk_widget_parent_class = NULL; static guint widget_signals[LAST_SIGNAL] = { 0 }; static GtkStyle *gtk_default_style = NULL; static guint composite_child_stack = 0; static GtkTextDirection gtk_default_direction = GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR; static GParamSpecPool *style_property_spec_pool = NULL; static GQuark quark_property_parser = 0; static GQuark quark_aux_info = 0; static GQuark quark_accel_path = 0; static GQuark quark_accel_closures = 0; static GQuark quark_event_mask = 0; static GQuark quark_device_event_mask = 0; static GQuark quark_parent_window = 0; static GQuark quark_pointer_window = 0; static GQuark quark_shape_info = 0; static GQuark quark_input_shape_info = 0; static GQuark quark_pango_context = 0; static GQuark quark_rc_style = 0; static GQuark quark_accessible_object = 0; static GQuark quark_mnemonic_labels = 0; static GQuark quark_tooltip_markup = 0; static GQuark quark_has_tooltip = 0; static GQuark quark_tooltip_window = 0; static GQuark quark_visual = 0; static GQuark quark_modifier_style = 0; static GQuark quark_enabled_devices = 0; static GQuark quark_size_groups = 0; GParamSpecPool *_gtk_widget_child_property_pool = NULL; GObjectNotifyContext *_gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context = NULL; /* --- functions --- */ GType gtk_widget_get_type (void) { static GType widget_type = 0; if (G_UNLIKELY (widget_type == 0)) { const GTypeInfo widget_info = { sizeof (GtkWidgetClass), NULL, /* base_init */ (GBaseFinalizeFunc) gtk_widget_base_class_finalize, (GClassInitFunc) gtk_widget_class_init, NULL, /* class_finalize */ NULL, /* class_init */ sizeof (GtkWidget), 0, /* n_preallocs */ (GInstanceInitFunc) gtk_widget_init, NULL, /* value_table */ }; const GInterfaceInfo accessibility_info = { (GInterfaceInitFunc) gtk_widget_accessible_interface_init, (GInterfaceFinalizeFunc) NULL, NULL /* interface data */ }; const GInterfaceInfo buildable_info = { (GInterfaceInitFunc) gtk_widget_buildable_interface_init, (GInterfaceFinalizeFunc) NULL, NULL /* interface data */ }; widget_type = g_type_register_static (G_TYPE_INITIALLY_UNOWNED, "GtkWidget", &widget_info, G_TYPE_FLAG_ABSTRACT); g_type_add_interface_static (widget_type, ATK_TYPE_IMPLEMENTOR, &accessibility_info) ; g_type_add_interface_static (widget_type, GTK_TYPE_BUILDABLE, &buildable_info) ; } return widget_type; } static void child_property_notify_dispatcher (GObject *object, guint n_pspecs, GParamSpec **pspecs) { GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (object)->dispatch_child_properties_changed (GTK_WIDGET (object), n_pspecs, pspecs); } /* We guard against the draw signal callbacks modifying the state of the * cairo context by surounding it with save/restore. * Maybe we should also cairo_new_path() just to be sure? */ static void gtk_widget_draw_marshaller (GClosure *closure, GValue *return_value, guint n_param_values, const GValue *param_values, gpointer invocation_hint, gpointer marshal_data) { cairo_t *cr = g_value_get_boxed (¶m_values[1]); cairo_save (cr); _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED (closure, return_value, n_param_values, param_values, invocation_hint, marshal_data); cairo_restore (cr); } static void gtk_widget_class_init (GtkWidgetClass *klass) { static GObjectNotifyContext cpn_context = { 0, NULL, NULL }; GObjectClass *gobject_class = G_OBJECT_CLASS (klass); GtkBindingSet *binding_set; gtk_widget_parent_class = g_type_class_peek_parent (klass); quark_property_parser = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-rc-property-parser"); quark_aux_info = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-aux-info"); quark_accel_path = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-accel-path"); quark_accel_closures = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-accel-closures"); quark_event_mask = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-event-mask"); quark_device_event_mask = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-device-event-mask"); quark_parent_window = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-parent-window"); quark_pointer_window = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-pointer-window"); quark_shape_info = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-shape-info"); quark_input_shape_info = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-input-shape-info"); quark_pango_context = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-pango-context"); quark_rc_style = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-rc-style"); quark_accessible_object = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-accessible-object"); quark_mnemonic_labels = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-mnemonic-labels"); quark_tooltip_markup = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-tooltip-markup"); quark_has_tooltip = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-has-tooltip"); quark_tooltip_window = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-tooltip-window"); quark_visual = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-visual"); quark_modifier_style = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-modifier-style"); quark_enabled_devices = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-enabled-devices"); quark_size_groups = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-size-groups"); style_property_spec_pool = g_param_spec_pool_new (FALSE); _gtk_widget_child_property_pool = g_param_spec_pool_new (TRUE); cpn_context.quark_notify_queue = g_quark_from_static_string ("GtkWidget-child-property-notify-queue"); cpn_context.dispatcher = child_property_notify_dispatcher; _gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context = &cpn_context; gobject_class->dispose = gtk_widget_dispose; gobject_class->finalize = gtk_widget_finalize; gobject_class->set_property = gtk_widget_set_property; gobject_class->get_property = gtk_widget_get_property; klass->destroy = gtk_widget_real_destroy; klass->activate_signal = 0; klass->dispatch_child_properties_changed = gtk_widget_dispatch_child_properties_changed; klass->show = gtk_widget_real_show; klass->show_all = gtk_widget_show; klass->hide = gtk_widget_real_hide; klass->map = gtk_widget_real_map; klass->unmap = gtk_widget_real_unmap; klass->realize = gtk_widget_real_realize; klass->unrealize = gtk_widget_real_unrealize; klass->size_allocate = gtk_widget_real_size_allocate; klass->get_request_mode = gtk_widget_real_get_request_mode; klass->get_preferred_width = gtk_widget_real_get_width; klass->get_preferred_height = gtk_widget_real_get_height; klass->get_preferred_width_for_height = gtk_widget_real_get_width_for_height; klass->get_preferred_height_for_width = gtk_widget_real_get_height_for_width; klass->state_changed = NULL; klass->parent_set = NULL; klass->hierarchy_changed = NULL; klass->style_set = gtk_widget_real_style_set; klass->direction_changed = gtk_widget_real_direction_changed; klass->grab_notify = NULL; klass->child_notify = NULL; klass->draw = NULL; klass->mnemonic_activate = gtk_widget_real_mnemonic_activate; klass->grab_focus = gtk_widget_real_grab_focus; klass->focus = gtk_widget_real_focus; klass->move_focus = gtk_widget_real_move_focus; klass->keynav_failed = gtk_widget_real_keynav_failed; klass->event = NULL; klass->button_press_event = NULL; klass->button_release_event = NULL; klass->motion_notify_event = NULL; klass->delete_event = NULL; klass->destroy_event = NULL; klass->key_press_event = gtk_widget_real_key_press_event; klass->key_release_event = gtk_widget_real_key_release_event; klass->enter_notify_event = NULL; klass->leave_notify_event = NULL; klass->configure_event = NULL; klass->focus_in_event = gtk_widget_real_focus_in_event; klass->focus_out_event = gtk_widget_real_focus_out_event; klass->map_event = NULL; klass->unmap_event = NULL; klass->window_state_event = NULL; klass->property_notify_event = _gtk_selection_property_notify; klass->selection_clear_event = _gtk_selection_clear; klass->selection_request_event = _gtk_selection_request; klass->selection_notify_event = _gtk_selection_notify; klass->selection_received = NULL; klass->proximity_in_event = NULL; klass->proximity_out_event = NULL; klass->drag_begin = NULL; klass->drag_end = NULL; klass->drag_data_delete = NULL; klass->drag_leave = NULL; klass->drag_motion = NULL; klass->drag_drop = NULL; klass->drag_data_received = NULL; klass->screen_changed = NULL; klass->can_activate_accel = gtk_widget_real_can_activate_accel; klass->grab_broken_event = NULL; klass->query_tooltip = gtk_widget_real_query_tooltip; klass->style_updated = gtk_widget_real_style_updated; klass->show_help = gtk_widget_real_show_help; /* Accessibility support */ klass->get_accessible = gtk_widget_real_get_accessible; klass->adjust_size_request = gtk_widget_real_adjust_size_request; klass->adjust_size_allocation = gtk_widget_real_adjust_size_allocation; g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_NAME, g_param_spec_string ("name", P_("Widget name"), P_("The name of the widget"), NULL, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_PARENT, g_param_spec_object ("parent", P_("Parent widget"), P_("The parent widget of this widget. Must be a Container widget"), GTK_TYPE_CONTAINER, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST, g_param_spec_int ("width-request", P_("Width request"), P_("Override for width request of the widget, or -1 if natural request should be used"), -1, G_MAXINT, -1, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST, g_param_spec_int ("height-request", P_("Height request"), P_("Override for height request of the widget, or -1 if natural request should be used"), -1, G_MAXINT, -1, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_VISIBLE, g_param_spec_boolean ("visible", P_("Visible"), P_("Whether the widget is visible"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_SENSITIVE, g_param_spec_boolean ("sensitive", P_("Sensitive"), P_("Whether the widget responds to input"), TRUE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_APP_PAINTABLE, g_param_spec_boolean ("app-paintable", P_("Application paintable"), P_("Whether the application will paint directly on the widget"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_CAN_FOCUS, g_param_spec_boolean ("can-focus", P_("Can focus"), P_("Whether the widget can accept the input focus"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_HAS_FOCUS, g_param_spec_boolean ("has-focus", P_("Has focus"), P_("Whether the widget has the input focus"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_IS_FOCUS, g_param_spec_boolean ("is-focus", P_("Is focus"), P_("Whether the widget is the focus widget within the toplevel"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_CAN_DEFAULT, g_param_spec_boolean ("can-default", P_("Can default"), P_("Whether the widget can be the default widget"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_HAS_DEFAULT, g_param_spec_boolean ("has-default", P_("Has default"), P_("Whether the widget is the default widget"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT, g_param_spec_boolean ("receives-default", P_("Receives default"), P_("If TRUE, the widget will receive the default action when it is focused"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_COMPOSITE_CHILD, g_param_spec_boolean ("composite-child", P_("Composite child"), P_("Whether the widget is part of a composite widget"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_STYLE, g_param_spec_object ("style", P_("Style"), P_("The style of the widget, which contains information about how it will look (colors etc)"), GTK_TYPE_STYLE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_EVENTS, g_param_spec_flags ("events", P_("Events"), P_("The event mask that decides what kind of GdkEvents this widget gets"), GDK_TYPE_EVENT_MASK, GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_NO_SHOW_ALL, g_param_spec_boolean ("no-show-all", P_("No show all"), P_("Whether gtk_widget_show_all() should not affect this widget"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:has-tooltip: * * Enables or disables the emission of #GtkWidget::query-tooltip on @widget. * A value of %TRUE indicates that @widget can have a tooltip, in this case * the widget will be queried using #GtkWidget::query-tooltip to determine * whether it will provide a tooltip or not. * * Note that setting this property to %TRUE for the first time will change * the event masks of the GdkWindows of this widget to include leave-notify * and motion-notify events. This cannot and will not be undone when the * property is set to %FALSE again. * * Since: 2.12 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP, g_param_spec_boolean ("has-tooltip", P_("Has tooltip"), P_("Whether this widget has a tooltip"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:tooltip-text: * * Sets the text of tooltip to be the given string. * * Also see gtk_tooltip_set_text(). * * This is a convenience property which will take care of getting the * tooltip shown if the given string is not %NULL: #GtkWidget:has-tooltip * will automatically be set to %TRUE and there will be taken care of * #GtkWidget::query-tooltip in the default signal handler. * * Since: 2.12 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT, g_param_spec_string ("tooltip-text", P_("Tooltip Text"), P_("The contents of the tooltip for this widget"), NULL, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:tooltip-markup: * * Sets the text of tooltip to be the given string, which is marked up * with the Pango text markup language. * Also see gtk_tooltip_set_markup(). * * This is a convenience property which will take care of getting the * tooltip shown if the given string is not %NULL: #GtkWidget:has-tooltip * will automatically be set to %TRUE and there will be taken care of * #GtkWidget::query-tooltip in the default signal handler. * * Since: 2.12 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP, g_param_spec_string ("tooltip-markup", P_("Tooltip markup"), P_("The contents of the tooltip for this widget"), NULL, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:window: * * The widget's window if it is realized, %NULL otherwise. * * Since: 2.14 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_WINDOW, g_param_spec_object ("window", P_("Window"), P_("The widget's window if it is realized"), GDK_TYPE_WINDOW, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); /** * GtkWidget:double-buffered * * Whether the widget is double buffered. * * Since: 2.18 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_DOUBLE_BUFFERED, g_param_spec_boolean ("double-buffered", P_("Double Buffered"), P_("Whether the widget is double buffered"), TRUE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:halign: * * How to distribute horizontal space if widget gets extra space, see #GtkAlign * * Since: 3.0 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_HALIGN, g_param_spec_enum ("halign", P_("Horizontal Alignment"), P_("How to position in extra horizontal space"), GTK_TYPE_ALIGN, GTK_ALIGN_FILL, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:valign: * * How to distribute vertical space if widget gets extra space, see #GtkAlign * * Since: 3.0 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_VALIGN, g_param_spec_enum ("valign", P_("Vertical Alignment"), P_("How to position in extra vertical space"), GTK_TYPE_ALIGN, GTK_ALIGN_FILL, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:margin-left * * Margin on left side of widget. * * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example. * * Since: 3.0 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_MARGIN_LEFT, g_param_spec_int ("margin-left", P_("Margin on Left"), P_("Pixels of extra space on the left side"), 0, G_MAXINT16, 0, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:margin-right * * Margin on right side of widget. * * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example. * * Since: 3.0 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_MARGIN_RIGHT, g_param_spec_int ("margin-right", P_("Margin on Right"), P_("Pixels of extra space on the right side"), 0, G_MAXINT16, 0, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:margin-top * * Margin on top side of widget. * * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example. * * Since: 3.0 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_MARGIN_TOP, g_param_spec_int ("margin-top", P_("Margin on Top"), P_("Pixels of extra space on the top side"), 0, G_MAXINT16, 0, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:margin-bottom * * Margin on bottom side of widget. * * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example. * * Since: 3.0 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM, g_param_spec_int ("margin-bottom", P_("Margin on Bottom"), P_("Pixels of extra space on the bottom side"), 0, G_MAXINT16, 0, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:margin * * Sets all four sides' margin at once. If read, returns max * margin on any side. * * Since: 3.0 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_MARGIN, g_param_spec_int ("margin", P_("All Margins"), P_("Pixels of extra space on all four sides"), 0, G_MAXINT16, 0, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget::destroy: * @object: the object which received the signal * * Signals that all holders of a reference to the widget should release * the reference that they hold. May result in finalization of the widget * if all references are released. */ widget_signals[DESTROY] = g_signal_new (I_("destroy"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_CLEANUP | G_SIGNAL_NO_RECURSE | G_SIGNAL_NO_HOOKS, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, destroy), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget:hexpand * * Whether to expand horizontally. See gtk_widget_set_hexpand(). * * Since: 3.0 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_HEXPAND, g_param_spec_boolean ("hexpand", P_("Horizontal Expand"), P_("Whether widget wants more horizontal space"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:hexpand-set * * Whether to use the #GtkWidget:hexpand property. See gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set(). * * Since: 3.0 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_HEXPAND_SET, g_param_spec_boolean ("hexpand-set", P_("Horizontal Expand Set"), P_("Whether to use the hexpand property"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:vexpand * * Whether to expand vertically. See gtk_widget_set_vexpand(). * * Since: 3.0 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_VEXPAND, g_param_spec_boolean ("vexpand", P_("Vertical Expand"), P_("Whether widget wants more vertical space"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:vexpand-set * * Whether to use the #GtkWidget:vexpand property. See gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set(). * * Since: 3.0 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_VEXPAND_SET, g_param_spec_boolean ("vexpand-set", P_("Vertical Expand Set"), P_("Whether to use the vexpand property"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget:expand * * Whether to expand in both directions. Setting this sets both #GtkWidget:hexpand and #GtkWidget:vexpand * * Since: 3.0 */ g_object_class_install_property (gobject_class, PROP_EXPAND, g_param_spec_boolean ("expand", P_("Expand Both"), P_("Whether widget wants to expand in both directions"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READWRITE)); /** * GtkWidget::show: * @widget: the object which received the signal. */ widget_signals[SHOW] = g_signal_new (I_("show"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, show), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::hide: * @widget: the object which received the signal. */ widget_signals[HIDE] = g_signal_new (I_("hide"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, hide), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::map: * @widget: the object which received the signal. */ widget_signals[MAP] = g_signal_new (I_("map"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, map), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::unmap: * @widget: the object which received the signal. */ widget_signals[UNMAP] = g_signal_new (I_("unmap"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, unmap), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::realize: * @widget: the object which received the signal. */ widget_signals[REALIZE] = g_signal_new (I_("realize"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, realize), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::unrealize: * @widget: the object which received the signal. */ widget_signals[UNREALIZE] = g_signal_new (I_("unrealize"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, unrealize), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::size-allocate: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @allocation: */ widget_signals[SIZE_ALLOCATE] = g_signal_new (I_("size-allocate"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, size_allocate), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__BOXED, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GDK_TYPE_RECTANGLE | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::state-changed: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @state: the previous state * * The ::state-changed signal is emitted when the widget state changes. * See gtk_widget_get_state(). * * Deprecated: 3.0. Use #GtkWidget::state-flags-changed instead. */ widget_signals[STATE_CHANGED] = g_signal_new (I_("state-changed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, state_changed), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__ENUM, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GTK_TYPE_STATE_TYPE); /** * GtkWidget::state-flags-changed: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @flags: The previous state flags. * * The ::state-flags-changed signal is emitted when the widget state * changes, see gtk_widget_get_state_flags(). * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_signals[STATE_FLAGS_CHANGED] = g_signal_new (I_("state-flags-changed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, state_flags_changed), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__FLAGS, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GTK_TYPE_STATE_FLAGS); /** * GtkWidget::parent-set: * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted * @old_parent: (allow-none): the previous parent, or %NULL if the widget * just got its initial parent. * * The ::parent-set signal is emitted when a new parent * has been set on a widget. */ widget_signals[PARENT_SET] = g_signal_new (I_("parent-set"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, parent_set), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET); /** * GtkWidget::hierarchy-changed: * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted * @previous_toplevel: (allow-none): the previous toplevel ancestor, or %NULL * if the widget was previously unanchored * * The ::hierarchy-changed signal is emitted when the * anchored state of a widget changes. A widget is * anchored when its toplevel * ancestor is a #GtkWindow. This signal is emitted when * a widget changes from un-anchored to anchored or vice-versa. */ widget_signals[HIERARCHY_CHANGED] = g_signal_new (I_("hierarchy-changed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, hierarchy_changed), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET); /** * GtkWidget::style-set: * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted * @previous_style: (allow-none): the previous style, or %NULL if the widget * just got its initial style * * The ::style-set signal is emitted when a new style has been set * on a widget. Note that style-modifying functions like * gtk_widget_modify_base() also cause this signal to be emitted. * * Note that this signal is emitted for changes to the deprecated * #GtkStyle. To track changes to the #GtkStyleContext associated * with a widget, use the #GtkWidget::style-updated signal. * * Deprecated:3.0: Use the #GtkWidget::style-updated signal */ widget_signals[STYLE_SET] = g_signal_new (I_("style-set"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, style_set), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GTK_TYPE_STYLE); /** * GtkWidget::style-updated: * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted * * The ::style-updated signal is emitted when the #GtkStyleContext * of a widget is changed. Note that style-modifying functions like * gtk_widget_override_color() also cause this signal to be emitted. * * Since: 3.0 */ widget_signals[STYLE_UPDATED] = g_signal_new (I_("style-updated"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, style_updated), NULL, NULL, g_cclosure_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::direction-changed: * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted * @previous_direction: the previous text direction of @widget * * The ::direction-changed signal is emitted when the text direction * of a widget changes. */ widget_signals[DIRECTION_CHANGED] = g_signal_new (I_("direction-changed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, direction_changed), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__ENUM, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GTK_TYPE_TEXT_DIRECTION); /** * GtkWidget::grab-notify: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @was_grabbed: %FALSE if the widget becomes shadowed, %TRUE * if it becomes unshadowed * * The ::grab-notify signal is emitted when a widget becomes * shadowed by a GTK+ grab (not a pointer or keyboard grab) on * another widget, or when it becomes unshadowed due to a grab * being removed. * * A widget is shadowed by a gtk_grab_add() when the topmost * grab widget in the grab stack of its window group is not * its ancestor. */ widget_signals[GRAB_NOTIFY] = g_signal_new (I_("grab-notify"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, grab_notify), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__BOOLEAN, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN); /** * GtkWidget::child-notify: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @pspec: the #GParamSpec of the changed child property * * The ::child-notify signal is emitted for each * child property that has * changed on an object. The signal's detail holds the property name. */ widget_signals[CHILD_NOTIFY] = g_signal_new (I_("child-notify"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST | G_SIGNAL_NO_RECURSE | G_SIGNAL_DETAILED | G_SIGNAL_NO_HOOKS, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, child_notify), NULL, NULL, g_cclosure_marshal_VOID__PARAM, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, G_TYPE_PARAM); /** * GtkWidget::draw: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @cr: the cairo context to draw to * * This signal is emitted when a widget is supposed to render itself. * The @widget's top left corner must be painted at the origin of * the passed in context and be sized to the values returned by * gtk_widget_get_allocated_width() and * gtk_widget_get_allocated_height(). * * Signal handlers connected to this signal can modify the cairo * context passed as @cr in any way they like and don't need to * restore it. The signal emission takes care of calling cairo_save() * before and cairo_restore() after invoking the handler. */ widget_signals[DRAW] = g_signal_new (I_("draw"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, draw), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, gtk_widget_draw_marshaller, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, CAIRO_GOBJECT_TYPE_CONTEXT); /** * GtkWidget::mnemonic-activate: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @arg1: */ widget_signals[MNEMONIC_ACTIVATE] = g_signal_new (I_("mnemonic-activate"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, mnemonic_activate), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOOLEAN, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN); /** * GtkWidget::grab-focus: * @widget: the object which received the signal. */ widget_signals[GRAB_FOCUS] = g_signal_new (I_("grab-focus"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, grab_focus), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::focus: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @direction: * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[FOCUS] = g_signal_new (I_("focus"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, focus), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__ENUM, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GTK_TYPE_DIRECTION_TYPE); /** * GtkWidget::move-focus: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @direction: */ widget_signals[MOVE_FOCUS] = g_signal_new (I_("move-focus"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, move_focus), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__ENUM, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GTK_TYPE_DIRECTION_TYPE); /** * GtkWidget::keynav-failed: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @direction: the direction of movement * * Gets emitted if keyboard navigation fails. * See gtk_widget_keynav_failed() for details. * * Returns: %TRUE if stopping keyboard navigation is fine, %FALSE * if the emitting widget should try to handle the keyboard * navigation attempt in its parent container(s). * * Since: 2.12 **/ widget_signals[KEYNAV_FAILED] = g_signal_new (I_("keynav-failed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, keynav_failed), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__ENUM, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GTK_TYPE_DIRECTION_TYPE); /** * GtkWidget::event: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: the #GdkEvent which triggered this signal * * The GTK+ main loop will emit three signals for each GDK event delivered * to a widget: one generic ::event signal, another, more specific, * signal that matches the type of event delivered (e.g. * #GtkWidget::key-press-event) and finally a generic * #GtkWidget::event-after signal. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event * and to cancel the emission of the second specific ::event signal. * %FALSE to propagate the event further and to allow the emission of * the second signal. The ::event-after signal is emitted regardless of * the return value. */ widget_signals[EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::event-after: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: the #GdkEvent which triggered this signal * * After the emission of the #GtkWidget::event signal and (optionally) * the second more specific signal, ::event-after will be emitted * regardless of the previous two signals handlers return values. * */ widget_signals[EVENT_AFTER] = g_signal_new (I_("event-after"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), 0, 0, NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__BOXED, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::button-press-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: (type Gdk.EventButton): the #GdkEventButton which triggered * this signal. * * The ::button-press-event signal will be emitted when a button * (typically from a mouse) is pressed. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the * widget needs to enable the #GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[BUTTON_PRESS_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("button-press-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, button_press_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::button-release-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: (type Gdk.EventButton): the #GdkEventButton which triggered * this signal. * * The ::button-release-event signal will be emitted when a button * (typically from a mouse) is released. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the * widget needs to enable the #GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[BUTTON_RELEASE_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("button-release-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, button_release_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::scroll-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: (type Gdk.EventScroll): the #GdkEventScroll which triggered * this signal. * * The ::scroll-event signal is emitted when a button in the 4 to 7 * range is pressed. Wheel mice are usually configured to generate * button press events for buttons 4 and 5 when the wheel is turned. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[SCROLL_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("scroll-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, scroll_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::motion-notify-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: (type Gdk.EventMotion): the #GdkEventMotion which triggered * this signal. * * The ::motion-notify-event signal is emitted when the pointer moves * over the widget's #GdkWindow. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget * needs to enable the #GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[MOTION_NOTIFY_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("motion-notify-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, motion_notify_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::composited-changed: * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted * * The ::composited-changed signal is emitted when the composited * status of @widgets screen changes. * See gdk_screen_is_composited(). */ widget_signals[COMPOSITED_CHANGED] = g_signal_new (I_("composited-changed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, composited_changed), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::delete-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: the event which triggered this signal * * The ::delete-event signal is emitted if a user requests that * a toplevel window is closed. The default handler for this signal * destroys the window. Connecting gtk_widget_hide_on_delete() to * this signal will cause the window to be hidden instead, so that * it can later be shown again without reconstructing it. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[DELETE_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("delete-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, delete_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::destroy-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: the event which triggered this signal * * The ::destroy-event signal is emitted when a #GdkWindow is destroyed. * You rarely get this signal, because most widgets disconnect themselves * from their window before they destroy it, so no widget owns the * window at destroy time. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable this mask * automatically for all new windows. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[DESTROY_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("destroy-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, destroy_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::key-press-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventKey): the #GdkEventKey which triggered this signal. * * The ::key-press-event signal is emitted when a key is pressed. The signal * emission will reoccur at the key-repeat rate when the key is kept pressed. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_KEY_PRESS_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[KEY_PRESS_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("key-press-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, key_press_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::key-release-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventKey): the #GdkEventKey which triggered this signal. * * The ::key-release-event signal is emitted when a key is released. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_KEY_RELEASE_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[KEY_RELEASE_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("key-release-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, key_release_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::enter-notify-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventCrossing): the #GdkEventCrossing which triggered * this signal. * * The ::enter-notify-event will be emitted when the pointer enters * the @widget's window. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[ENTER_NOTIFY_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("enter-notify-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, enter_notify_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::leave-notify-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventCrossing): the #GdkEventCrossing which triggered * this signal. * * The ::leave-notify-event will be emitted when the pointer leaves * the @widget's window. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[LEAVE_NOTIFY_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("leave-notify-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, leave_notify_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::configure-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventConfigure): the #GdkEventConfigure which triggered * this signal. * * The ::configure-event signal will be emitted when the size, position or * stacking of the @widget's window has changed. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable this mask * automatically for all new windows. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[CONFIGURE_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("configure-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, configure_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::focus-in-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventFocus): the #GdkEventFocus which triggered * this signal. * * The ::focus-in-event signal will be emitted when the keyboard focus * enters the @widget's window. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE_MASK mask. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[FOCUS_IN_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("focus-in-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, focus_in_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::focus-out-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventFocus): the #GdkEventFocus which triggered this * signal. * * The ::focus-out-event signal will be emitted when the keyboard focus * leaves the @widget's window. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE_MASK mask. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[FOCUS_OUT_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("focus-out-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, focus_out_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::map-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventAny): the #GdkEventAny which triggered this signal. * * The ::map-event signal will be emitted when the @widget's window is * mapped. A window is mapped when it becomes visible on the screen. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable this mask * automatically for all new windows. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[MAP_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("map-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, map_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::unmap-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventAny): the #GdkEventAny which triggered this signal * * The ::unmap-event signal will be emitted when the @widget's window is * unmapped. A window is unmapped when it becomes invisible on the screen. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable this mask * automatically for all new windows. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[UNMAP_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("unmap-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, unmap_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::property-notify-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventProperty): the #GdkEventProperty which triggered * this signal. * * The ::property-notify-event signal will be emitted when a property on * the @widget's window has been changed or deleted. * * To receive this signal, the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_PROPERTY_CHANGE_MASK mask. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[PROPERTY_NOTIFY_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("property-notify-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, property_notify_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::selection-clear-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventSelection): the #GdkEventSelection which triggered * this signal. * * The ::selection-clear-event signal will be emitted when the * the @widget's window has lost ownership of a selection. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("selection-clear-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, selection_clear_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::selection-request-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventSelection): the #GdkEventSelection which triggered * this signal. * * The ::selection-request-event signal will be emitted when * another client requests ownership of the selection owned by * the @widget's window. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("selection-request-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, selection_request_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::selection-notify-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @event: (type Gdk.EventSelection): * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[SELECTION_NOTIFY_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("selection-notify-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, selection_notify_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::selection-received: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @data: * @time: */ widget_signals[SELECTION_RECEIVED] = g_signal_new (I_("selection-received"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, selection_received), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__BOXED_UINT, G_TYPE_NONE, 2, GTK_TYPE_SELECTION_DATA | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE, G_TYPE_UINT); /** * GtkWidget::selection-get: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @data: * @info: * @time: */ widget_signals[SELECTION_GET] = g_signal_new (I_("selection-get"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, selection_get), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__BOXED_UINT_UINT, G_TYPE_NONE, 3, GTK_TYPE_SELECTION_DATA | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE, G_TYPE_UINT, G_TYPE_UINT); /** * GtkWidget::proximity-in-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventProximity): the #GdkEventProximity which triggered * this signal. * * To receive this signal the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_PROXIMITY_IN_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[PROXIMITY_IN_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("proximity-in-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, proximity_in_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::proximity-out-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventProximity): the #GdkEventProximity which triggered * this signal. * * To receive this signal the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_PROXIMITY_OUT_MASK mask. * * This signal will be sent to the grab widget if there is one. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[PROXIMITY_OUT_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("proximity-out-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, proximity_out_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::drag-leave: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @drag_context: the drag context * @time: the timestamp of the motion event * * The ::drag-leave signal is emitted on the drop site when the cursor * leaves the widget. A typical reason to connect to this signal is to * undo things done in #GtkWidget::drag-motion, e.g. undo highlighting * with gtk_drag_unhighlight() */ widget_signals[DRAG_LEAVE] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-leave"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_leave), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT_UINT, G_TYPE_NONE, 2, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT, G_TYPE_UINT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-begin: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @drag_context: the drag context * * The ::drag-begin signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag is * started. A typical reason to connect to this signal is to set up a * custom drag icon with gtk_drag_source_set_icon(). * * Note that some widgets set up a drag icon in the default handler of * this signal, so you may have to use g_signal_connect_after() to * override what the default handler did. */ widget_signals[DRAG_BEGIN] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-begin"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_begin), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-end: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @drag_context: the drag context * * The ::drag-end signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag is * finished. A typical reason to connect to this signal is to undo * things done in #GtkWidget::drag-begin. */ widget_signals[DRAG_END] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-end"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_end), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-data-delete: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @drag_context: the drag context * * The ::drag-data-delete signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag * with the action %GDK_ACTION_MOVE is successfully completed. The signal * handler is responsible for deleting the data that has been dropped. What * "delete" means depends on the context of the drag operation. */ widget_signals[DRAG_DATA_DELETE] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-data-delete"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_data_delete), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-failed: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @drag_context: the drag context * @result: the result of the drag operation * * The ::drag-failed signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag has * failed. The signal handler may hook custom code to handle a failed DND * operation based on the type of error, it returns %TRUE is the failure has * been already handled (not showing the default "drag operation failed" * animation), otherwise it returns %FALSE. * * Return value: %TRUE if the failed drag operation has been already handled. * * Since: 2.12 */ widget_signals[DRAG_FAILED] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-failed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_failed), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT_ENUM, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 2, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT, GTK_TYPE_DRAG_RESULT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-motion: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @drag_context: the drag context * @x: the x coordinate of the current cursor position * @y: the y coordinate of the current cursor position * @time: the timestamp of the motion event * @returns: whether the cursor position is in a drop zone * * The drag-motion signal is emitted on the drop site when the user * moves the cursor over the widget during a drag. The signal handler * must determine whether the cursor position is in a drop zone or not. * If it is not in a drop zone, it returns %FALSE and no further processing * is necessary. Otherwise, the handler returns %TRUE. In this case, the * handler is responsible for providing the necessary information for * displaying feedback to the user, by calling gdk_drag_status(). * * If the decision whether the drop will be accepted or rejected can't be * made based solely on the cursor position and the type of the data, the * handler may inspect the dragged data by calling gtk_drag_get_data() and * defer the gdk_drag_status() call to the #GtkWidget::drag-data-received * handler. Note that you cannot not pass #GTK_DEST_DEFAULT_DROP, * #GTK_DEST_DEFAULT_MOTION or #GTK_DEST_DEFAULT_ALL to gtk_drag_dest_set() * when using the drag-motion signal that way. * * Also note that there is no drag-enter signal. The drag receiver has to * keep track of whether he has received any drag-motion signals since the * last #GtkWidget::drag-leave and if not, treat the drag-motion signal as * an "enter" signal. Upon an "enter", the handler will typically highlight * the drop site with gtk_drag_highlight(). * |[ * static void * drag_motion (GtkWidget *widget, * GdkDragContext *context, * gint x, * gint y, * guint time) * { * GdkAtom target; * * PrivateData *private_data = GET_PRIVATE_DATA (widget); * * if (!private_data->drag_highlight) * { * private_data->drag_highlight = 1; * gtk_drag_highlight (widget); * } * * target = gtk_drag_dest_find_target (widget, context, NULL); * if (target == GDK_NONE) * gdk_drag_status (context, 0, time); * else * { * private_data->pending_status = context->suggested_action; * gtk_drag_get_data (widget, context, target, time); * } * * return TRUE; * } * * static void * drag_data_received (GtkWidget *widget, * GdkDragContext *context, * gint x, * gint y, * GtkSelectionData *selection_data, * guint info, * guint time) * { * PrivateData *private_data = GET_PRIVATE_DATA (widget); * * if (private_data->suggested_action) * { * private_data->suggested_action = 0; * * /* We are getting this data due to a request in drag_motion, * * rather than due to a request in drag_drop, so we are just * * supposed to call gdk_drag_status (), not actually paste in * * the data. * */ * str = gtk_selection_data_get_text (selection_data); * if (!data_is_acceptable (str)) * gdk_drag_status (context, 0, time); * else * gdk_drag_status (context, private_data->suggested_action, time); * } * else * { * /* accept the drop */ * } * } * ]| */ widget_signals[DRAG_MOTION] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-motion"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_motion), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT_INT_INT_UINT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 4, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT, G_TYPE_INT, G_TYPE_INT, G_TYPE_UINT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-drop: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @drag_context: the drag context * @x: the x coordinate of the current cursor position * @y: the y coordinate of the current cursor position * @time: the timestamp of the motion event * @returns: whether the cursor position is in a drop zone * * The ::drag-drop signal is emitted on the drop site when the user drops * the data onto the widget. The signal handler must determine whether * the cursor position is in a drop zone or not. If it is not in a drop * zone, it returns %FALSE and no further processing is necessary. * Otherwise, the handler returns %TRUE. In this case, the handler must * ensure that gtk_drag_finish() is called to let the source know that * the drop is done. The call to gtk_drag_finish() can be done either * directly or in a #GtkWidget::drag-data-received handler which gets * triggered by calling gtk_drag_get_data() to receive the data for one * or more of the supported targets. */ widget_signals[DRAG_DROP] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-drop"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_drop), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT_INT_INT_UINT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 4, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT, G_TYPE_INT, G_TYPE_INT, G_TYPE_UINT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-data-get: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @drag_context: the drag context * @data: the #GtkSelectionData to be filled with the dragged data * @info: the info that has been registered with the target in the * #GtkTargetList * @time: the timestamp at which the data was requested * * The ::drag-data-get signal is emitted on the drag source when the drop * site requests the data which is dragged. It is the responsibility of * the signal handler to fill @data with the data in the format which * is indicated by @info. See gtk_selection_data_set() and * gtk_selection_data_set_text(). */ widget_signals[DRAG_DATA_GET] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-data-get"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_data_get), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT_BOXED_UINT_UINT, G_TYPE_NONE, 4, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT, GTK_TYPE_SELECTION_DATA | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE, G_TYPE_UINT, G_TYPE_UINT); /** * GtkWidget::drag-data-received: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @drag_context: the drag context * @x: where the drop happened * @y: where the drop happened * @data: the received data * @info: the info that has been registered with the target in the * #GtkTargetList * @time: the timestamp at which the data was received * * The ::drag-data-received signal is emitted on the drop site when the * dragged data has been received. If the data was received in order to * determine whether the drop will be accepted, the handler is expected * to call gdk_drag_status() and not finish the drag. * If the data was received in response to a #GtkWidget::drag-drop signal * (and this is the last target to be received), the handler for this * signal is expected to process the received data and then call * gtk_drag_finish(), setting the @success parameter depending on whether * the data was processed successfully. * * The handler may inspect and modify @drag_context->action before calling * gtk_drag_finish(), e.g. to implement %GDK_ACTION_ASK as shown in the * following example: * |[ * void * drag_data_received (GtkWidget *widget, * GdkDragContext *drag_context, * gint x, * gint y, * GtkSelectionData *data, * guint info, * guint time) * { * if ((data->length >= 0) && (data->format == 8)) * { * if (drag_context->action == GDK_ACTION_ASK) * { * GtkWidget *dialog; * gint response; * * dialog = gtk_message_dialog_new (NULL, * GTK_DIALOG_MODAL | * GTK_DIALOG_DESTROY_WITH_PARENT, * GTK_MESSAGE_INFO, * GTK_BUTTONS_YES_NO, * "Move the data ?\n"); * response = gtk_dialog_run (GTK_DIALOG (dialog)); * gtk_widget_destroy (dialog); * * if (response == GTK_RESPONSE_YES) * drag_context->action = GDK_ACTION_MOVE; * else * drag_context->action = GDK_ACTION_COPY; * } * * gtk_drag_finish (drag_context, TRUE, FALSE, time); * return; * } * * gtk_drag_finish (drag_context, FALSE, FALSE, time); * } * ]| */ widget_signals[DRAG_DATA_RECEIVED] = g_signal_new (I_("drag-data-received"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_data_received), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT_INT_INT_BOXED_UINT_UINT, G_TYPE_NONE, 6, GDK_TYPE_DRAG_CONTEXT, G_TYPE_INT, G_TYPE_INT, GTK_TYPE_SELECTION_DATA | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE, G_TYPE_UINT, G_TYPE_UINT); /** * GtkWidget::visibility-notify-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventVisibility): the #GdkEventVisibility which * triggered this signal. * * The ::visibility-notify-event will be emitted when the @widget's window * is obscured or unobscured. * * To receive this signal the #GdkWindow associated to the widget needs * to enable the #GDK_VISIBILITY_NOTIFY_MASK mask. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[VISIBILITY_NOTIFY_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("visibility-notify-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, visibility_notify_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::window-state-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventWindowState): the #GdkEventWindowState which * triggered this signal. * * The ::window-state-event will be emitted when the state of the * toplevel window associated to the @widget changes. * * To receive this signal the #GdkWindow associated to the widget * needs to enable the #GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK mask. GDK will enable * this mask automatically for all new windows. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the * event. %FALSE to propagate the event further. */ widget_signals[WINDOW_STATE_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("window-state-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, window_state_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::damage-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventExpose): the #GdkEventExpose event * * Emitted when a redirected window belonging to @widget gets drawn into. * The region/area members of the event shows what area of the redirected * drawable was drawn into. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. * %FALSE to propagate the event further. * * Since: 2.14 */ widget_signals[DAMAGE_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("damage-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, damage_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::grab-broken-event: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @event: (type Gdk.EventGrabBroken): the #GdkEventGrabBroken event * * Emitted when a pointer or keyboard grab on a window belonging * to @widget gets broken. * * On X11, this happens when the grab window becomes unviewable * (i.e. it or one of its ancestors is unmapped), or if the same * application grabs the pointer or keyboard again. * * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for * the event. %FALSE to propagate the event further. * * Since: 2.8 */ widget_signals[GRAB_BROKEN_EVENT] = g_signal_new (I_("grab-broken-event"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, grab_broken_event), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOXED, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GDK_TYPE_EVENT | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); /** * GtkWidget::query-tooltip: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @x: the x coordinate of the cursor position where the request has * been emitted, relative to @widget's left side * @y: the y coordinate of the cursor position where the request has * been emitted, relative to @widget's top * @keyboard_mode: %TRUE if the tooltip was trigged using the keyboard * @tooltip: a #GtkTooltip * * Emitted when #GtkWidget:has-tooltip is %TRUE and the #GtkSettings:gtk-tooltip-timeout * has expired with the cursor hovering "above" @widget; or emitted when @widget got * focus in keyboard mode. * * Using the given coordinates, the signal handler should determine * whether a tooltip should be shown for @widget. If this is the case * %TRUE should be returned, %FALSE otherwise. Note that if * @keyboard_mode is %TRUE, the values of @x and @y are undefined and * should not be used. * * The signal handler is free to manipulate @tooltip with the therefore * destined function calls. * * Returns: %TRUE if @tooltip should be shown right now, %FALSE otherwise. * * Since: 2.12 */ widget_signals[QUERY_TOOLTIP] = g_signal_new (I_("query-tooltip"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, query_tooltip), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__INT_INT_BOOLEAN_OBJECT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 4, G_TYPE_INT, G_TYPE_INT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, GTK_TYPE_TOOLTIP); /** * GtkWidget::popup-menu * @widget: the object which received the signal * * This signal gets emitted whenever a widget should pop up a context * menu. This usually happens through the standard key binding mechanism; * by pressing a certain key while a widget is focused, the user can cause * the widget to pop up a menu. For example, the #GtkEntry widget creates * a menu with clipboard commands. See * for an example of how to use this signal. * * Returns: %TRUE if a menu was activated */ widget_signals[POPUP_MENU] = g_signal_new (I_("popup-menu"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, popup_menu), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__VOID, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 0); /** * GtkWidget::show-help: * @widget: the object which received the signal. * @help_type: */ widget_signals[SHOW_HELP] = g_signal_new (I_("show-help"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, show_help), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__ENUM, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET_HELP_TYPE); /** * GtkWidget::accel-closures-changed: * @widget: the object which received the signal. */ widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED] = g_signal_new (I_("accel-closures-changed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), 0, 0, NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__VOID, G_TYPE_NONE, 0); /** * GtkWidget::screen-changed: * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted * @previous_screen: (allow-none): the previous screen, or %NULL if the * widget was not associated with a screen before * * The ::screen-changed signal gets emitted when the * screen of a widget has changed. */ widget_signals[SCREEN_CHANGED] = g_signal_new (I_("screen-changed"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, screen_changed), NULL, NULL, _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT, G_TYPE_NONE, 1, GDK_TYPE_SCREEN); /** * GtkWidget::can-activate-accel: * @widget: the object which received the signal * @signal_id: the ID of a signal installed on @widget * * Determines whether an accelerator that activates the signal * identified by @signal_id can currently be activated. * This signal is present to allow applications and derived * widgets to override the default #GtkWidget handling * for determining whether an accelerator can be activated. * * Returns: %TRUE if the signal can be activated. */ widget_signals[CAN_ACTIVATE_ACCEL] = g_signal_new (I_("can-activate-accel"), G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, can_activate_accel), _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__UINT, G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, G_TYPE_UINT); binding_set = gtk_binding_set_by_class (klass); gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_F10, GDK_SHIFT_MASK, "popup-menu", 0); gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_Menu, 0, "popup-menu", 0); gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_F1, GDK_CONTROL_MASK, "show-help", 1, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET_HELP_TYPE, GTK_WIDGET_HELP_TOOLTIP); gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_KP_F1, GDK_CONTROL_MASK, "show-help", 1, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET_HELP_TYPE, GTK_WIDGET_HELP_TOOLTIP); gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_F1, GDK_SHIFT_MASK, "show-help", 1, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET_HELP_TYPE, GTK_WIDGET_HELP_WHATS_THIS); gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_KP_F1, GDK_SHIFT_MASK, "show-help", 1, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET_HELP_TYPE, GTK_WIDGET_HELP_WHATS_THIS); gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_boolean ("interior-focus", P_("Interior Focus"), P_("Whether to draw the focus indicator inside widgets"), TRUE, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_int ("focus-line-width", P_("Focus linewidth"), P_("Width, in pixels, of the focus indicator line"), 0, G_MAXINT, 1, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_string ("focus-line-pattern", P_("Focus line dash pattern"), P_("Dash pattern used to draw the focus indicator"), "\1\1", GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_int ("focus-padding", P_("Focus padding"), P_("Width, in pixels, between focus indicator and the widget 'box'"), 0, G_MAXINT, 1, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_boxed ("cursor-color", P_("Cursor color"), P_("Color with which to draw insertion cursor"), GDK_TYPE_COLOR, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_boxed ("secondary-cursor-color", P_("Secondary cursor color"), P_("Color with which to draw the secondary insertion cursor when editing mixed right-to-left and left-to-right text"), GDK_TYPE_COLOR, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_float ("cursor-aspect-ratio", P_("Cursor line aspect ratio"), P_("Aspect ratio with which to draw insertion cursor"), 0.0, 1.0, 0.04, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_boolean ("window-dragging", P_("Window dragging"), P_("Whether windows can be dragged by clicking on empty areas"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); /** * GtkWidget:link-color: * * The "link-color" style property defines the color of unvisited links. * * Since: 2.10 */ gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_boxed ("link-color", P_("Unvisited Link Color"), P_("Color of unvisited links"), GDK_TYPE_COLOR, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); /** * GtkWidget:visited-link-color: * * The "visited-link-color" style property defines the color of visited links. * * Since: 2.10 */ gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_boxed ("visited-link-color", P_("Visited Link Color"), P_("Color of visited links"), GDK_TYPE_COLOR, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); /** * GtkWidget:wide-separators: * * The "wide-separators" style property defines whether separators have * configurable width and should be drawn using a box instead of a line. * * Since: 2.10 */ gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_boolean ("wide-separators", P_("Wide Separators"), P_("Whether separators have configurable width and should be drawn using a box instead of a line"), FALSE, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); /** * GtkWidget:separator-width: * * The "separator-width" style property defines the width of separators. * This property only takes effect if #GtkWidget:wide-separators is %TRUE. * * Since: 2.10 */ gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_int ("separator-width", P_("Separator Width"), P_("The width of separators if wide-separators is TRUE"), 0, G_MAXINT, 0, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); /** * GtkWidget:separator-height: * * The "separator-height" style property defines the height of separators. * This property only takes effect if #GtkWidget:wide-separators is %TRUE. * * Since: 2.10 */ gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_int ("separator-height", P_("Separator Height"), P_("The height of separators if \"wide-separators\" is TRUE"), 0, G_MAXINT, 0, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); /** * GtkWidget:scroll-arrow-hlength: * * The "scroll-arrow-hlength" style property defines the length of * horizontal scroll arrows. * * Since: 2.10 */ gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_int ("scroll-arrow-hlength", P_("Horizontal Scroll Arrow Length"), P_("The length of horizontal scroll arrows"), 1, G_MAXINT, 16, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); /** * GtkWidget:scroll-arrow-vlength: * * The "scroll-arrow-vlength" style property defines the length of * vertical scroll arrows. * * Since: 2.10 */ gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (klass, g_param_spec_int ("scroll-arrow-vlength", P_("Vertical Scroll Arrow Length"), P_("The length of vertical scroll arrows"), 1, G_MAXINT, 16, GTK_PARAM_READABLE)); g_type_class_add_private (klass, sizeof (GtkWidgetPrivate)); } static void gtk_widget_base_class_finalize (GtkWidgetClass *klass) { GList *list, *node; list = g_param_spec_pool_list_owned (style_property_spec_pool, G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (klass)); for (node = list; node; node = node->next) { GParamSpec *pspec = node->data; g_param_spec_pool_remove (style_property_spec_pool, pspec); g_param_spec_unref (pspec); } g_list_free (list); } static void gtk_widget_set_property (GObject *object, guint prop_id, const GValue *value, GParamSpec *pspec) { GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); switch (prop_id) { gboolean tmp; gchar *tooltip_markup; const gchar *tooltip_text; GtkWindow *tooltip_window; case PROP_NAME: gtk_widget_set_name (widget, g_value_get_string (value)); break; case PROP_PARENT: gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (g_value_get_object (value)), widget); break; case PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST: gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, g_value_get_int (value), -2, 0); break; case PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST: gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, -2, g_value_get_int (value), 0); break; case PROP_VISIBLE: gtk_widget_set_visible (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_SENSITIVE: gtk_widget_set_sensitive (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_APP_PAINTABLE: gtk_widget_set_app_paintable (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_CAN_FOCUS: gtk_widget_set_can_focus (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_HAS_FOCUS: if (g_value_get_boolean (value)) gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget); break; case PROP_IS_FOCUS: if (g_value_get_boolean (value)) gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget); break; case PROP_CAN_DEFAULT: gtk_widget_set_can_default (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_HAS_DEFAULT: if (g_value_get_boolean (value)) gtk_widget_grab_default (widget); break; case PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT: gtk_widget_set_receives_default (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_STYLE: gtk_widget_set_style (widget, g_value_get_object (value)); break; case PROP_EVENTS: if (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget) && gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) gtk_widget_set_events (widget, g_value_get_flags (value)); break; case PROP_NO_SHOW_ALL: gtk_widget_set_no_show_all (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP: gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value), FALSE); break; case PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP: tooltip_window = g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_window); tooltip_markup = g_value_dup_string (value); /* Treat an empty string as a NULL string, * because an empty string would be useless for a tooltip: */ if (tooltip_markup && (strlen (tooltip_markup) == 0)) { g_free (tooltip_markup); tooltip_markup = NULL; } g_object_set_qdata_full (object, quark_tooltip_markup, tooltip_markup, g_free); tmp = (tooltip_window != NULL || tooltip_markup != NULL); gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget, tmp, FALSE); if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query (widget); break; case PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT: tooltip_window = g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_window); tooltip_text = g_value_get_string (value); /* Treat an empty string as a NULL string, * because an empty string would be useless for a tooltip: */ if (tooltip_text && (strlen (tooltip_text) == 0)) tooltip_text = NULL; tooltip_markup = tooltip_text ? g_markup_escape_text (tooltip_text, -1) : NULL; g_object_set_qdata_full (object, quark_tooltip_markup, tooltip_markup, g_free); tmp = (tooltip_window != NULL || tooltip_markup != NULL); gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget, tmp, FALSE); if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query (widget); break; case PROP_DOUBLE_BUFFERED: gtk_widget_set_double_buffered (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_HALIGN: gtk_widget_set_halign (widget, g_value_get_enum (value)); break; case PROP_VALIGN: gtk_widget_set_valign (widget, g_value_get_enum (value)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_LEFT: gtk_widget_set_margin_left (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_RIGHT: gtk_widget_set_margin_right (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_TOP: gtk_widget_set_margin_top (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM: gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); break; case PROP_MARGIN: g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); gtk_widget_set_margin_left (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); gtk_widget_set_margin_right (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); gtk_widget_set_margin_top (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); break; case PROP_HEXPAND: gtk_widget_set_hexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_HEXPAND_SET: gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_VEXPAND: gtk_widget_set_vexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_VEXPAND_SET: gtk_widget_set_vexpand_set (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); break; case PROP_EXPAND: g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); gtk_widget_set_hexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); gtk_widget_set_vexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); break; default: G_OBJECT_WARN_INVALID_PROPERTY_ID (object, prop_id, pspec); break; } } static void gtk_widget_get_property (GObject *object, guint prop_id, GValue *value, GParamSpec *pspec) { GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; switch (prop_id) { gpointer *eventp; case PROP_NAME: if (priv->name) g_value_set_string (value, priv->name); else g_value_set_static_string (value, ""); break; case PROP_PARENT: g_value_set_object (value, priv->parent); break; case PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST: { int w; gtk_widget_get_size_request (widget, &w, NULL); g_value_set_int (value, w); } break; case PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST: { int h; gtk_widget_get_size_request (widget, NULL, &h); g_value_set_int (value, h); } break; case PROP_VISIBLE: g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) != FALSE)); break; case PROP_SENSITIVE: g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_get_sensitive (widget) != FALSE)); break; case PROP_APP_PAINTABLE: g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_get_app_paintable (widget) != FALSE)); break; case PROP_CAN_FOCUS: g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_get_can_focus (widget) != FALSE)); break; case PROP_HAS_FOCUS: g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_has_focus (widget) != FALSE)); break; case PROP_IS_FOCUS: g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_is_focus (widget))); break; case PROP_CAN_DEFAULT: g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_get_can_default (widget) != FALSE)); break; case PROP_HAS_DEFAULT: g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_has_default (widget) != FALSE)); break; case PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT: g_value_set_boolean (value, (gtk_widget_get_receives_default (widget) != FALSE)); break; case PROP_COMPOSITE_CHILD: g_value_set_boolean (value, widget->priv->composite_child); break; case PROP_STYLE: g_value_set_object (value, gtk_widget_get_style (widget)); break; case PROP_EVENTS: eventp = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_event_mask); g_value_set_flags (value, GPOINTER_TO_INT (eventp)); break; case PROP_NO_SHOW_ALL: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_no_show_all (widget)); break; case PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP: g_value_set_boolean (value, GPOINTER_TO_UINT (g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_has_tooltip))); break; case PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT: { gchar *escaped = g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_markup); gchar *text = NULL; if (escaped && !pango_parse_markup (escaped, -1, 0, NULL, &text, NULL, NULL)) g_assert (NULL == text); /* text should still be NULL in case of markup errors */ g_value_take_string (value, text); } break; case PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP: g_value_set_string (value, g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_markup)); break; case PROP_WINDOW: g_value_set_object (value, gtk_widget_get_window (widget)); break; case PROP_DOUBLE_BUFFERED: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_double_buffered (widget)); break; case PROP_HALIGN: g_value_set_enum (value, gtk_widget_get_halign (widget)); break; case PROP_VALIGN: g_value_set_enum (value, gtk_widget_get_valign (widget)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_LEFT: g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_left (widget)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_RIGHT: g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_right (widget)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_TOP: g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_top (widget)); break; case PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM: g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_bottom (widget)); break; case PROP_MARGIN: { GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, FALSE); if (aux_info == NULL) { g_value_set_int (value, 0); } else { g_value_set_int (value, MAX (MAX (aux_info->margin.left, aux_info->margin.right), MAX (aux_info->margin.top, aux_info->margin.bottom))); } } break; case PROP_HEXPAND: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_hexpand (widget)); break; case PROP_HEXPAND_SET: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set (widget)); break; case PROP_VEXPAND: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_vexpand (widget)); break; case PROP_VEXPAND_SET: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set (widget)); break; case PROP_EXPAND: g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_hexpand (widget) && gtk_widget_get_vexpand (widget)); break; default: G_OBJECT_WARN_INVALID_PROPERTY_ID (object, prop_id, pspec); break; } } static void gtk_widget_init (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; widget->priv = G_TYPE_INSTANCE_GET_PRIVATE (widget, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET, GtkWidgetPrivate); priv = widget->priv; priv->child_visible = TRUE; priv->name = NULL; priv->allocation.x = -1; priv->allocation.y = -1; priv->allocation.width = 1; priv->allocation.height = 1; priv->window = NULL; priv->parent = NULL; priv->sensitive = TRUE; priv->composite_child = composite_child_stack != 0; priv->double_buffered = TRUE; priv->redraw_on_alloc = TRUE; priv->width_request_needed = TRUE; priv->height_request_needed = TRUE; priv->alloc_needed = TRUE; /* this will be set to TRUE if the widget gets a child or if the * expand flag is set on the widget, but until one of those happen * we know the expand is already properly FALSE. * * We really want to default FALSE here to avoid computing expand * all over the place while initially building a widget tree. */ priv->need_compute_expand = FALSE; priv->style = gtk_widget_get_default_style (); g_object_ref (priv->style); } static void gtk_widget_dispatch_child_properties_changed (GtkWidget *widget, guint n_pspecs, GParamSpec **pspecs) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; GtkWidget *container = priv->parent; guint i; for (i = 0; widget->priv->parent == container && i < n_pspecs; i++) g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[CHILD_NOTIFY], g_quark_from_string (pspecs[i]->name), pspecs[i]); } /** * gtk_widget_freeze_child_notify: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Stops emission of #GtkWidget::child-notify signals on @widget. The * signals are queued until gtk_widget_thaw_child_notify() is called * on @widget. * * This is the analogue of g_object_freeze_notify() for child properties. **/ void gtk_widget_freeze_child_notify (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (!G_OBJECT (widget)->ref_count) return; g_object_ref (widget); g_object_notify_queue_freeze (G_OBJECT (widget), _gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context); g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_child_notify: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @child_property: the name of a child property installed on the * class of @widget's parent * * Emits a #GtkWidget::child-notify signal for the * child property @child_property * on @widget. * * This is the analogue of g_object_notify() for child properties. **/ void gtk_widget_child_notify (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *child_property) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; GParamSpec *pspec; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (child_property != NULL); if (!G_OBJECT (widget)->ref_count || !priv->parent) return; g_object_ref (widget); pspec = g_param_spec_pool_lookup (_gtk_widget_child_property_pool, child_property, G_OBJECT_TYPE (priv->parent), TRUE); if (!pspec) g_warning ("%s: container class `%s' has no child property named `%s'", G_STRLOC, G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (priv->parent), child_property); else { GObjectNotifyQueue *nqueue = g_object_notify_queue_freeze (G_OBJECT (widget), _gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context); g_object_notify_queue_add (G_OBJECT (widget), nqueue, pspec); g_object_notify_queue_thaw (G_OBJECT (widget), nqueue); } g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_thaw_child_notify: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Reverts the effect of a previous call to gtk_widget_freeze_child_notify(). * This causes all queued #GtkWidget::child-notify signals on @widget to be * emitted. */ void gtk_widget_thaw_child_notify (GtkWidget *widget) { GObjectNotifyQueue *nqueue; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (!G_OBJECT (widget)->ref_count) return; g_object_ref (widget); nqueue = g_object_notify_queue_from_object (G_OBJECT (widget), _gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context); if (!nqueue || !nqueue->freeze_count) g_warning (G_STRLOC ": child-property-changed notification for %s(%p) is not frozen", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); else g_object_notify_queue_thaw (G_OBJECT (widget), nqueue); g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_new: * @type: type ID of the widget to create * @first_property_name: name of first property to set * @Varargs: value of first property, followed by more properties, * %NULL-terminated * * This is a convenience function for creating a widget and setting * its properties in one go. For example you might write: * gtk_widget_new (GTK_TYPE_LABEL, "label", "Hello World", "xalign", * 0.0, NULL) to create a left-aligned label. Equivalent to * g_object_new(), but returns a widget so you don't have to * cast the object yourself. * * Return value: a new #GtkWidget of type @widget_type **/ GtkWidget* gtk_widget_new (GType type, const gchar *first_property_name, ...) { GtkWidget *widget; va_list var_args; g_return_val_if_fail (g_type_is_a (type, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET), NULL); va_start (var_args, first_property_name); widget = (GtkWidget *)g_object_new_valist (type, first_property_name, var_args); va_end (var_args); return widget; } static inline void gtk_widget_queue_draw_child (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; GtkWidget *parent; parent = priv->parent; if (parent && gtk_widget_is_drawable (parent)) gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (parent, priv->allocation.x, priv->allocation.y, priv->allocation.width, priv->allocation.height); } /** * gtk_widget_unparent: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function is only for use in widget implementations. * Should be called by implementations of the remove method * on #GtkContainer, to dissociate a child from the container. **/ void gtk_widget_unparent (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GObjectNotifyQueue *nqueue; GtkWidget *toplevel; GtkWidget *old_parent; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; if (priv->parent == NULL) return; /* keep this function in sync with gtk_menu_detach() */ gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); nqueue = g_object_notify_queue_freeze (G_OBJECT (widget), _gtk_widget_child_property_notify_context); toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel)) _gtk_window_unset_focus_and_default (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget); if (gtk_container_get_focus_child (GTK_CONTAINER (priv->parent)) == widget) gtk_container_set_focus_child (GTK_CONTAINER (priv->parent), NULL); gtk_widget_queue_draw_child (widget); /* Reset the width and height here, to force reallocation if we * get added back to a new parent. This won't work if our new * allocation is smaller than 1x1 and we actually want a size of 1x1... * (would 0x0 be OK here?) */ priv->allocation.width = 1; priv->allocation.height = 1; if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) { if (priv->in_reparent) gtk_widget_unmap (widget); else gtk_widget_unrealize (widget); } /* If we are unanchoring the child, we save around the toplevel * to emit hierarchy changed */ if (priv->parent->priv->anchored) g_object_ref (toplevel); else toplevel = NULL; /* Removing a widget from a container restores the child visible * flag to the default state, so it doesn't affect the child * in the next parent. */ priv->child_visible = TRUE; old_parent = priv->parent; priv->parent = NULL; /* parent may no longer expand if the removed * child was expand=TRUE and could therefore * be forcing it to. */ if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) && (priv->need_compute_expand || priv->computed_hexpand || priv->computed_vexpand)) { gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (old_parent); } g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[PARENT_SET], 0, old_parent); if (toplevel) { _gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed (widget, toplevel); g_object_unref (toplevel); } /* Now that the parent pointer is nullified and the hierarchy-changed * already passed, go ahead and unset the parent window, if we are unparenting * an embeded GtkWindow the window will become toplevel again and hierarchy-changed * will fire again for the new subhierarchy. */ gtk_widget_set_parent_window (widget, NULL); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "parent"); g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); if (!priv->parent) g_object_notify_queue_clear (G_OBJECT (widget), nqueue); g_object_notify_queue_thaw (G_OBJECT (widget), nqueue); gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_destroy: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Destroys a widget. * * When a widget is * destroyed, it will break any references it holds to other objects. * If the widget is inside a container, the widget will be removed * from the container. If the widget is a toplevel (derived from * #GtkWindow), it will be removed from the list of toplevels, and the * reference GTK+ holds to it will be removed. Removing a * widget from its container or the list of toplevels results in the * widget being finalized, unless you've added additional references * to the widget with g_object_ref(). * * In most cases, only toplevel widgets (windows) require explicit * destruction, because when you destroy a toplevel its children will * be destroyed as well. **/ void gtk_widget_destroy (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (!widget->priv->in_destruction) g_object_run_dispose (G_OBJECT (widget)); } /** * gtk_widget_destroyed: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @widget_pointer: (inout) (transfer none): address of a variable that contains @widget * * This function sets *@widget_pointer to %NULL if @widget_pointer != * %NULL. It's intended to be used as a callback connected to the * "destroy" signal of a widget. You connect gtk_widget_destroyed() * as a signal handler, and pass the address of your widget variable * as user data. Then when the widget is destroyed, the variable will * be set to %NULL. Useful for example to avoid multiple copies * of the same dialog. **/ void gtk_widget_destroyed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget **widget_pointer) { /* Don't make any assumptions about the * value of widget! * Even check widget_pointer. */ if (widget_pointer) *widget_pointer = NULL; } /** * gtk_widget_show: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Flags a widget to be displayed. Any widget that isn't shown will * not appear on the screen. If you want to show all the widgets in a * container, it's easier to call gtk_widget_show_all() on the * container, instead of individually showing the widgets. * * Remember that you have to show the containers containing a widget, * in addition to the widget itself, before it will appear onscreen. * * When a toplevel container is shown, it is immediately realized and * mapped; other shown widgets are realized and mapped when their * toplevel container is realized and mapped. **/ void gtk_widget_show (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (!gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) { g_object_ref (widget); gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); if (!gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); /* see comment in set_parent() for why this should and can be * conditional */ if (widget->priv->need_compute_expand || widget->priv->computed_hexpand || widget->priv->computed_vexpand) { if (widget->priv->parent != NULL) gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (widget->priv->parent); } g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[SHOW], 0); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "visible"); gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); g_object_unref (widget); } } static void gtk_widget_real_show (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (!gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) { priv->visible = TRUE; if (priv->parent && gtk_widget_get_mapped (priv->parent) && gtk_widget_get_child_visible (widget) && !gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) gtk_widget_map (widget); } } static void gtk_widget_show_map_callback (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEvent *event, gint *flag) { *flag = TRUE; g_signal_handlers_disconnect_by_func (widget, gtk_widget_show_map_callback, flag); } /** * gtk_widget_show_now: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Shows a widget. If the widget is an unmapped toplevel widget * (i.e. a #GtkWindow that has not yet been shown), enter the main * loop and wait for the window to actually be mapped. Be careful; * because the main loop is running, anything can happen during * this function. **/ void gtk_widget_show_now (GtkWidget *widget) { gint flag = FALSE; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); /* make sure we will get event */ if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget) && gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) { gtk_widget_show (widget); g_signal_connect (widget, "map-event", G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_show_map_callback), &flag); while (!flag) gtk_main_iteration (); } else gtk_widget_show (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_hide: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Reverses the effects of gtk_widget_show(), causing the widget to be * hidden (invisible to the user). **/ void gtk_widget_hide (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) { GtkWidget *toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); g_object_ref (widget); gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); if (toplevel != widget && gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel)) _gtk_window_unset_focus_and_default (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget); /* a parent may now be expand=FALSE since we're hidden. */ if (widget->priv->need_compute_expand || widget->priv->computed_hexpand || widget->priv->computed_vexpand) { gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (widget); } g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[HIDE], 0); if (!gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "visible"); gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); g_object_unref (widget); } } static void gtk_widget_real_hide (GtkWidget *widget) { if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) { widget->priv->visible = FALSE; if (gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) gtk_widget_unmap (widget); } } /** * gtk_widget_hide_on_delete: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Utility function; intended to be connected to the #GtkWidget::delete-event * signal on a #GtkWindow. The function calls gtk_widget_hide() on its * argument, then returns %TRUE. If connected to ::delete-event, the * result is that clicking the close button for a window (on the * window frame, top right corner usually) will hide but not destroy * the window. By default, GTK+ destroys windows when ::delete-event * is received. * * Return value: %TRUE **/ gboolean gtk_widget_hide_on_delete (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); gtk_widget_hide (widget); return TRUE; } /** * gtk_widget_show_all: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Recursively shows a widget, and any child widgets (if the widget is * a container). **/ void gtk_widget_show_all (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetClass *class; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (gtk_widget_get_no_show_all (widget)) return; class = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget); if (class->show_all) class->show_all (widget); } static void _gtk_widget_notify_state_change (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateFlags flag, gboolean target) { GtkStateType state; switch (flag) { case GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE: state = GTK_STATE_ACTIVE; break; case GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT: state = GTK_STATE_PRELIGHT; break; case GTK_STATE_FLAG_SELECTED: state = GTK_STATE_SELECTED; break; case GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE: state = GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE; break; case GTK_STATE_FLAG_INCONSISTENT: state = GTK_STATE_INCONSISTENT; break; case GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED: state = GTK_STATE_FOCUSED; break; default: return; } gtk_style_context_notify_state_change (widget->priv->context, gtk_widget_get_window (widget), NULL, state, target); } /* Initializes state transitions for those states that * were enabled before mapping and have a looping animation. */ static void _gtk_widget_start_state_transitions (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkStateFlags state, flag; if (!widget->priv->context) return; state = gtk_widget_get_state_flags (widget); flag = GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED; while (flag) { GtkAnimationDescription *animation_desc; if ((state & flag) == 0) { flag >>= 1; continue; } gtk_style_context_get (widget->priv->context, state, "transition", &animation_desc, NULL); if (animation_desc) { if (_gtk_animation_description_get_loop (animation_desc)) _gtk_widget_notify_state_change (widget, flag, TRUE); _gtk_animation_description_unref (animation_desc); } flag >>= 1; } } /** * gtk_widget_map: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function is only for use in widget implementations. Causes * a widget to be mapped if it isn't already. **/ void gtk_widget_map (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)); g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_child_visible (widget)); priv = widget->priv; if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) { gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); if (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) gtk_widget_realize (widget); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[MAP], 0); if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) gdk_window_invalidate_rect (priv->window, &priv->allocation, FALSE); gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); _gtk_widget_start_state_transitions (widget); } } /** * gtk_widget_unmap: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function is only for use in widget implementations. Causes * a widget to be unmapped if it's currently mapped. **/ void gtk_widget_unmap (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; if (gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) { gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) gdk_window_invalidate_rect (priv->window, &priv->allocation, FALSE); _gtk_tooltip_hide (widget); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[UNMAP], 0); gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); if (priv->context) gtk_style_context_cancel_animations (priv->context, NULL); /* Unset pointer/window info */ g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pointer_window, NULL); } } static void _gtk_widget_enable_device_events (GtkWidget *widget) { GHashTable *device_events; GHashTableIter iter; gpointer key, value; device_events = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_device_event_mask); if (!device_events) return; g_hash_table_iter_init (&iter, device_events); while (g_hash_table_iter_next (&iter, &key, &value)) { GdkDevice *device; GdkEventMask event_mask; device = key; event_mask = GPOINTER_TO_UINT (value); gtk_widget_add_events_internal (widget, device, event_mask); } } static GList * get_widget_windows (GtkWidget *widget) { GList *window_list, *last, *l, *children, *ret; if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) window_list = g_list_prepend (NULL, gtk_widget_get_window (widget)); else window_list = gdk_window_peek_children (gtk_widget_get_window (widget)); last = g_list_last (window_list); ret = NULL; for (l = window_list; l; l = l->next) { GtkWidget *window_widget = NULL; gdk_window_get_user_data (l->data, (gpointer *) &window_widget); if (widget != window_widget) continue; ret = g_list_prepend (ret, l->data); children = gdk_window_peek_children (GDK_WINDOW (l->data)); if (children) { last = g_list_concat (last, children); last = g_list_last (last); } } g_list_free (window_list); return ret; } static void device_enable_foreach (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer user_data) { GdkDevice *device = user_data; gtk_widget_set_device_enabled_internal (widget, device, TRUE, TRUE); } static void device_disable_foreach (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer user_data) { GdkDevice *device = user_data; gtk_widget_set_device_enabled_internal (widget, device, TRUE, FALSE); } static void gtk_widget_set_device_enabled_internal (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device, gboolean recurse, gboolean enabled) { GList *window_list, *l; window_list = get_widget_windows (widget); for (l = window_list; l; l = l->next) { GdkEventMask events = 0; GdkWindow *window; window = l->data; if (enabled) events = gdk_window_get_events (window); gdk_window_set_device_events (window, device, events); } if (recurse && GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) { if (enabled) gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), device_enable_foreach, device); else gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), device_disable_foreach, device); } g_list_free (window_list); } static void gtk_widget_update_devices_mask (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean recurse) { GList *enabled_devices, *l; enabled_devices = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_enabled_devices); for (l = enabled_devices; l; l = l->next) gtk_widget_set_device_enabled_internal (widget, GDK_DEVICE (l->data), recurse, TRUE); } /** * gtk_widget_realize: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Creates the GDK (windowing system) resources associated with a * widget. For example, @widget->window will be created when a widget * is realized. Normally realization happens implicitly; if you show * a widget and all its parent containers, then the widget will be * realized and mapped automatically. * * Realizing a widget requires all * the widget's parent widgets to be realized; calling * gtk_widget_realize() realizes the widget's parents in addition to * @widget itself. If a widget is not yet inside a toplevel window * when you realize it, bad things will happen. * * This function is primarily used in widget implementations, and * isn't very useful otherwise. Many times when you think you might * need it, a better approach is to connect to a signal that will be * called after the widget is realized automatically, such as * #GtkWidget::draw. Or simply g_signal_connect () to the * #GtkWidget::realize signal. **/ void gtk_widget_realize (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; cairo_region_t *region; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (widget->priv->anchored || GTK_IS_INVISIBLE (widget)); priv = widget->priv; if (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) { gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); /* if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget) && gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) g_message ("gtk_widget_realize(%s)", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget)); */ if (priv->parent == NULL && !gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) g_warning ("Calling gtk_widget_realize() on a widget that isn't " "inside a toplevel window is not going to work very well. " "Widgets must be inside a toplevel container before realizing them."); if (priv->parent && !gtk_widget_get_realized (priv->parent)) gtk_widget_realize (priv->parent); gtk_widget_ensure_style (widget); if (priv->style_update_pending) g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[STYLE_UPDATED], 0); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[REALIZE], 0); gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget, GPOINTER_TO_UINT (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_has_tooltip)), TRUE); if (priv->has_shape_mask) { region = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_shape_info); gdk_window_shape_combine_region (priv->window, region, 0, 0); } region = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info); if (region) gdk_window_input_shape_combine_region (priv->window, region, 0, 0); if (priv->multidevice) gdk_window_set_support_multidevice (priv->window, TRUE); _gtk_widget_enable_device_events (widget); gtk_widget_update_devices_mask (widget, TRUE); gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); } } /** * gtk_widget_unrealize: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function is only useful in widget implementations. * Causes a widget to be unrealized (frees all GDK resources * associated with the widget, such as @widget->window). **/ void gtk_widget_unrealize (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); if (widget->priv->has_shape_mask) gtk_widget_shape_combine_region (widget, NULL); if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info)) gtk_widget_input_shape_combine_region (widget, NULL); if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) { g_object_ref (widget); if (widget->priv->mapped) gtk_widget_unmap (widget); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[UNREALIZE], 0); g_assert (!widget->priv->mapped); gtk_widget_set_realized (widget, FALSE); g_object_unref (widget); } gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); } /***************************************** * Draw queueing. *****************************************/ /** * gtk_widget_queue_draw_region: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @region: region to draw * * Invalidates the rectangular area of @widget defined by @region by * calling gdk_window_invalidate_region() on the widget's window and * all its child windows. Once the main loop becomes idle (after the * current batch of events has been processed, roughly), the window * will receive expose events for the union of all regions that have * been invalidated. * * Normally you would only use this function in widget * implementations. You might also use it to schedule a redraw of a * #GtkDrawingArea or some portion thereof. * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_queue_draw_region (GtkWidget *widget, const cairo_region_t *region) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GtkWidget *w; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; if (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) return; /* Just return if the widget or one of its ancestors isn't mapped */ for (w = widget; w != NULL; w = w->priv->parent) if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (w)) return; gdk_window_invalidate_region (priv->window, region, TRUE); } /** * gtk_widget_queue_draw_area: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @x: x coordinate of upper-left corner of rectangle to redraw * @y: y coordinate of upper-left corner of rectangle to redraw * @width: width of region to draw * @height: height of region to draw * * Convenience function that calls gtk_widget_queue_draw_region() on * the region created from the given coordinates. * * The region here is specified in widget coordinates. * Widget coordinates are a bit odd; for historical reasons, they are * defined as @widget->window coordinates for widgets that are not * #GTK_NO_WINDOW widgets, and are relative to @widget->allocation.x, * @widget->allocation.y for widgets that are #GTK_NO_WINDOW widgets. */ void gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (GtkWidget *widget, gint x, gint y, gint width, gint height) { GdkRectangle rect; cairo_region_t *region; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); rect.x = x; rect.y = y; rect.width = width; rect.height = height; region = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&rect); gtk_widget_queue_draw_region (widget, region); cairo_region_destroy (region); } /** * gtk_widget_queue_draw: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Equivalent to calling gtk_widget_queue_draw_area() for the * entire area of a widget. **/ void gtk_widget_queue_draw (GtkWidget *widget) { GdkRectangle rect; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_get_allocation (widget, &rect); if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (widget, rect.x, rect.y, rect.width, rect.height); else gtk_widget_queue_draw_area (widget, 0, 0, rect.width, rect.height); } /** * gtk_widget_queue_resize: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function is only for use in widget implementations. * Flags a widget to have its size renegotiated; should * be called when a widget for some reason has a new size request. * For example, when you change the text in a #GtkLabel, #GtkLabel * queues a resize to ensure there's enough space for the new text. * * You cannot call gtk_widget_queue_resize() on a widget * from inside its implementation of the GtkWidgetClass::size_allocate * virtual method. Calls to gtk_widget_queue_resize() from inside * GtkWidgetClass::size_allocate will be silently ignored. **/ void gtk_widget_queue_resize (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_shallow_draw (widget); _gtk_size_group_queue_resize (widget, 0); } /** * gtk_widget_queue_resize_no_redraw: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function works like gtk_widget_queue_resize(), * except that the widget is not invalidated. * * Since: 2.4 **/ void gtk_widget_queue_resize_no_redraw (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); _gtk_size_group_queue_resize (widget, 0); } /** * gtk_widget_size_request: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @requisition: (out): a #GtkRequisition to be filled in * * This function is typically used when implementing a #GtkContainer * subclass. Obtains the preferred size of a widget. The container * uses this information to arrange its child widgets and decide what * size allocations to give them with gtk_widget_size_allocate(). * * You can also call this function from an application, with some * caveats. Most notably, getting a size request requires the widget * to be associated with a screen, because font information may be * needed. Multihead-aware applications should keep this in mind. * * Also remember that the size request is not necessarily the size * a widget will actually be allocated. * * Deprecated: 3.0: Use gtk_widget_get_preferred_size() instead. **/ void gtk_widget_size_request (GtkWidget *widget, GtkRequisition *requisition) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_get_preferred_size (widget, requisition, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_get_child_requisition: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @requisition: (out): a #GtkRequisition to be filled in * * This function is only for use in widget implementations. Obtains * @widget->requisition, unless someone has forced a particular * geometry on the widget (e.g. with gtk_widget_set_size_request()), * in which case it returns that geometry instead of the widget's * requisition. * * This function differs from gtk_widget_size_request() in that * it retrieves the last size request value from @widget->requisition, * while gtk_widget_size_request() actually calls the "size_request" method * on @widget to compute the size request and fill in @widget->requisition, * and only then returns @widget->requisition. * * Because this function does not call the "size_request" method, it * can only be used when you know that @widget->requisition is * up-to-date, that is, gtk_widget_size_request() has been called * since the last time a resize was queued. In general, only container * implementations have this information; applications should use * gtk_widget_size_request(). * * * Deprecated: 3.0: Use gtk_widget_get_preferred_size() instead. **/ void gtk_widget_get_child_requisition (GtkWidget *widget, GtkRequisition *requisition) { gtk_widget_get_preferred_size (widget, requisition, NULL); } static gboolean invalidate_predicate (GdkWindow *window, gpointer data) { gpointer user_data; gdk_window_get_user_data (window, &user_data); return (user_data == data); } /* Invalidate @region in widget->window and all children * of widget->window owned by widget. @region is in the * same coordinates as widget->allocation and will be * modified by this call. */ static void gtk_widget_invalidate_widget_windows (GtkWidget *widget, cairo_region_t *region) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) return; if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget) && priv->parent) { int x, y; gdk_window_get_position (priv->window, &x, &y); cairo_region_translate (region, -x, -y); } gdk_window_invalidate_maybe_recurse (priv->window, region, invalidate_predicate, widget); } /** * gtk_widget_queue_shallow_draw: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Like gtk_widget_queue_draw(), but only windows owned * by @widget are invalidated. **/ static void gtk_widget_queue_shallow_draw (GtkWidget *widget) { GdkRectangle rect; cairo_region_t *region; if (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) return; gtk_widget_get_allocation (widget, &rect); region = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&rect); gtk_widget_invalidate_widget_windows (widget, region); cairo_region_destroy (region); } /** * gtk_widget_size_allocate: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @allocation: position and size to be allocated to @widget * * This function is only used by #GtkContainer subclasses, to assign a size * and position to their child widgets. * * In this function, the allocation may be adjusted. It will be forced * to a 1x1 minimum size, and the adjust_size_allocation virtual * method on the child will be used to adjust the allocation. Standard * adjustments include removing the widget's margins, and applying the * widget's #GtkWidget:halign and #GtkWidget:valign properties. **/ void gtk_widget_size_allocate (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAllocation *allocation) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GdkRectangle real_allocation; GdkRectangle old_allocation; GdkRectangle adjusted_allocation; gboolean alloc_needed; gboolean size_changed; gboolean position_changed; gint natural_width, natural_height, dummy; gint min_width, min_height; priv = widget->priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG if (gtk_get_debug_flags () & GTK_DEBUG_GEOMETRY) { gint depth; GtkWidget *parent; const gchar *name; depth = 0; parent = widget; while (parent) { depth++; parent = gtk_widget_get_parent (parent); } name = g_type_name (G_OBJECT_TYPE (G_OBJECT (widget))); g_print ("gtk_widget_size_allocate: %*s%s %d %d\n", 2 * depth, " ", name, allocation->width, allocation->height); } #endif /* G_ENABLE_DEBUG */ alloc_needed = priv->alloc_needed; if (!priv->width_request_needed && !priv->height_request_needed) /* Preserve request/allocate ordering */ priv->alloc_needed = FALSE; old_allocation = priv->allocation; real_allocation = *allocation; adjusted_allocation = real_allocation; if (gtk_widget_get_request_mode (widget) == GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_HEIGHT_FOR_WIDTH) { /* Go ahead and request the height for allocated width, note that the internals * of get_height_for_width will internally limit the for_size to natural size * when aligning implicitly. */ gtk_widget_get_preferred_width (widget, &min_width, &natural_width); gtk_widget_get_preferred_height_for_width (widget, real_allocation.width, &min_height, &natural_height); } else { /* Go ahead and request the width for allocated height, note that the internals * of get_width_for_height will internally limit the for_size to natural size * when aligning implicitly. */ gtk_widget_get_preferred_height (widget, &min_height, &natural_height); gtk_widget_get_preferred_width_for_height (widget, real_allocation.height, &min_width, &natural_width); } if ((min_width > real_allocation.width || min_height > real_allocation.height) && !GTK_IS_SCROLLABLE (widget)) g_warning ("gtk_widget_size_allocate(): attempt to underallocate %s%s %s %p. " "Allocation is %dx%d, but minimum required size is %dx%d.", priv->parent ? G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (priv->parent) : "", priv->parent ? "'s child" : "toplevel", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget, real_allocation.width, real_allocation.height, min_width, min_height); /* Now that we have the right natural height and width, go ahead and remove any margins from the * allocated sizes and possibly limit them to the natural sizes */ GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->adjust_size_allocation (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, &dummy, &natural_width, &adjusted_allocation.x, &adjusted_allocation.width); GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->adjust_size_allocation (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, &dummy, &natural_height, &adjusted_allocation.y, &adjusted_allocation.height); if (adjusted_allocation.x < real_allocation.x || adjusted_allocation.y < real_allocation.y || (adjusted_allocation.x + adjusted_allocation.width) > (real_allocation.x + real_allocation.width) || (adjusted_allocation.y + adjusted_allocation.height > real_allocation.y + real_allocation.height)) { g_warning ("%s %p attempted to adjust its size allocation from %d,%d %dx%d to %d,%d %dx%d. adjust_size_allocation must keep allocation inside original bounds", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget, real_allocation.x, real_allocation.y, real_allocation.width, real_allocation.height, adjusted_allocation.x, adjusted_allocation.y, adjusted_allocation.width, adjusted_allocation.height); adjusted_allocation = real_allocation; /* veto it */ } else { real_allocation = adjusted_allocation; } if (real_allocation.width < 0 || real_allocation.height < 0) { g_warning ("gtk_widget_size_allocate(): attempt to allocate widget with width %d and height %d", real_allocation.width, real_allocation.height); } real_allocation.width = MAX (real_allocation.width, 1); real_allocation.height = MAX (real_allocation.height, 1); size_changed = (old_allocation.width != real_allocation.width || old_allocation.height != real_allocation.height); position_changed = (old_allocation.x != real_allocation.x || old_allocation.y != real_allocation.y); if (!alloc_needed && !size_changed && !position_changed) goto out; g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[SIZE_ALLOCATE], 0, &real_allocation); /* Size allocation is god... after consulting god, no further requests or allocations are needed */ priv->width_request_needed = FALSE; priv->height_request_needed = FALSE; priv->alloc_needed = FALSE; if (gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) { if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget) && priv->redraw_on_alloc && position_changed) { /* Invalidate union(old_allaction,priv->allocation) in priv->window */ cairo_region_t *invalidate = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&priv->allocation); cairo_region_union_rectangle (invalidate, &old_allocation); gdk_window_invalidate_region (priv->window, invalidate, FALSE); cairo_region_destroy (invalidate); } if (size_changed) { if (priv->redraw_on_alloc) { /* Invalidate union(old_allaction,priv->allocation) in priv->window and descendents owned by widget */ cairo_region_t *invalidate = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&priv->allocation); cairo_region_union_rectangle (invalidate, &old_allocation); gtk_widget_invalidate_widget_windows (widget, invalidate); cairo_region_destroy (invalidate); } } if (size_changed || position_changed) { GtkStyleContext *context; context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget); _gtk_style_context_invalidate_animation_areas (context); } } if ((size_changed || position_changed) && priv->parent && gtk_widget_get_realized (priv->parent) && _gtk_container_get_reallocate_redraws (GTK_CONTAINER (priv->parent))) { cairo_region_t *invalidate = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&priv->parent->priv->allocation); gtk_widget_invalidate_widget_windows (priv->parent, invalidate); cairo_region_destroy (invalidate); } out: gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_common_ancestor: * @widget_a: a #GtkWidget * @widget_b: a #GtkWidget * * Find the common ancestor of @widget_a and @widget_b that * is closest to the two widgets. * * Return value: the closest common ancestor of @widget_a and * @widget_b or %NULL if @widget_a and @widget_b do not * share a common ancestor. **/ static GtkWidget * gtk_widget_common_ancestor (GtkWidget *widget_a, GtkWidget *widget_b) { GtkWidget *parent_a; GtkWidget *parent_b; gint depth_a = 0; gint depth_b = 0; parent_a = widget_a; while (parent_a->priv->parent) { parent_a = parent_a->priv->parent; depth_a++; } parent_b = widget_b; while (parent_b->priv->parent) { parent_b = parent_b->priv->parent; depth_b++; } if (parent_a != parent_b) return NULL; while (depth_a > depth_b) { widget_a = widget_a->priv->parent; depth_a--; } while (depth_b > depth_a) { widget_b = widget_b->priv->parent; depth_b--; } while (widget_a != widget_b) { widget_a = widget_a->priv->parent; widget_b = widget_b->priv->parent; } return widget_a; } /** * gtk_widget_translate_coordinates: * @src_widget: a #GtkWidget * @dest_widget: a #GtkWidget * @src_x: X position relative to @src_widget * @src_y: Y position relative to @src_widget * @dest_x: (out): location to store X position relative to @dest_widget * @dest_y: (out): location to store Y position relative to @dest_widget * * Translate coordinates relative to @src_widget's allocation to coordinates * relative to @dest_widget's allocations. In order to perform this * operation, both widgets must be realized, and must share a common * toplevel. * * Return value: %FALSE if either widget was not realized, or there * was no common ancestor. In this case, nothing is stored in * *@dest_x and *@dest_y. Otherwise %TRUE. **/ gboolean gtk_widget_translate_coordinates (GtkWidget *src_widget, GtkWidget *dest_widget, gint src_x, gint src_y, gint *dest_x, gint *dest_y) { GtkWidgetPrivate *src_priv = src_widget->priv; GtkWidgetPrivate *dest_priv = dest_widget->priv; GtkWidget *ancestor; GdkWindow *window; GList *dest_list = NULL; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (src_widget), FALSE); g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (dest_widget), FALSE); ancestor = gtk_widget_common_ancestor (src_widget, dest_widget); if (!ancestor || !gtk_widget_get_realized (src_widget) || !gtk_widget_get_realized (dest_widget)) return FALSE; /* Translate from allocation relative to window relative */ if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (src_widget) && src_priv->parent) { gint wx, wy; gdk_window_get_position (src_priv->window, &wx, &wy); src_x -= wx - src_priv->allocation.x; src_y -= wy - src_priv->allocation.y; } else { src_x += src_priv->allocation.x; src_y += src_priv->allocation.y; } /* Translate to the common ancestor */ window = src_priv->window; while (window != ancestor->priv->window) { gdouble dx, dy; gdk_window_coords_to_parent (window, src_x, src_y, &dx, &dy); src_x = dx; src_y = dy; window = gdk_window_get_effective_parent (window); if (!window) /* Handle GtkHandleBox */ return FALSE; } /* And back */ window = dest_priv->window; while (window != ancestor->priv->window) { dest_list = g_list_prepend (dest_list, window); window = gdk_window_get_effective_parent (window); if (!window) /* Handle GtkHandleBox */ { g_list_free (dest_list); return FALSE; } } while (dest_list) { gdouble dx, dy; gdk_window_coords_from_parent (dest_list->data, src_x, src_y, &dx, &dy); src_x = dx; src_y = dy; dest_list = g_list_remove (dest_list, dest_list->data); } /* Translate from window relative to allocation relative */ if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (dest_widget) && dest_priv->parent) { gint wx, wy; gdk_window_get_position (dest_priv->window, &wx, &wy); src_x += wx - dest_priv->allocation.x; src_y += wy - dest_priv->allocation.y; } else { src_x -= dest_priv->allocation.x; src_y -= dest_priv->allocation.y; } if (dest_x) *dest_x = src_x; if (dest_y) *dest_y = src_y; return TRUE; } static void gtk_widget_real_size_allocate (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAllocation *allocation) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; priv->allocation = *allocation; if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget) && gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) { gdk_window_move_resize (priv->window, allocation->x, allocation->y, allocation->width, allocation->height); } } /* translate initial/final into start/end */ static GtkAlign effective_align (GtkAlign align, GtkTextDirection direction) { switch (align) { case GTK_ALIGN_START: return direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL ? GTK_ALIGN_END : GTK_ALIGN_START; case GTK_ALIGN_END: return direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL ? GTK_ALIGN_START : GTK_ALIGN_END; default: return align; } } static void adjust_for_align (GtkAlign align, gint *natural_size, gint *allocated_pos, gint *allocated_size) { switch (align) { case GTK_ALIGN_FILL: /* change nothing */ break; case GTK_ALIGN_START: /* keep *allocated_pos where it is */ *allocated_size = MIN (*allocated_size, *natural_size); break; case GTK_ALIGN_END: if (*allocated_size > *natural_size) { *allocated_pos += (*allocated_size - *natural_size); *allocated_size = *natural_size; } break; case GTK_ALIGN_CENTER: if (*allocated_size > *natural_size) { *allocated_pos += (*allocated_size - *natural_size) / 2; *allocated_size = MIN (*allocated_size, *natural_size); } break; } } static void adjust_for_margin(gint start_margin, gint end_margin, gint *minimum_size, gint *natural_size, gint *allocated_pos, gint *allocated_size) { *minimum_size -= (start_margin + end_margin); *natural_size -= (start_margin + end_margin); *allocated_pos += start_margin; *allocated_size -= (start_margin + end_margin); } static void gtk_widget_real_adjust_size_allocation (GtkWidget *widget, GtkOrientation orientation, gint *minimum_size, gint *natural_size, gint *allocated_pos, gint *allocated_size) { const GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info; aux_info = _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget); if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) { adjust_for_margin (aux_info->margin.left, aux_info->margin.right, minimum_size, natural_size, allocated_pos, allocated_size); adjust_for_align (effective_align (aux_info->halign, gtk_widget_get_direction (widget)), natural_size, allocated_pos, allocated_size); } else { adjust_for_margin (aux_info->margin.top, aux_info->margin.bottom, minimum_size, natural_size, allocated_pos, allocated_size); adjust_for_align (effective_align (aux_info->valign, GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE), natural_size, allocated_pos, allocated_size); } } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_can_activate_accel (GtkWidget *widget, guint signal_id) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; /* widgets must be onscreen for accels to take effect */ return gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget) && gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget) && gdk_window_is_viewable (priv->window); } /** * gtk_widget_can_activate_accel: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @signal_id: the ID of a signal installed on @widget * * Determines whether an accelerator that activates the signal * identified by @signal_id can currently be activated. * This is done by emitting the #GtkWidget::can-activate-accel * signal on @widget; if the signal isn't overridden by a * handler or in a derived widget, then the default check is * that the widget must be sensitive, and the widget and all * its ancestors mapped. * * Return value: %TRUE if the accelerator can be activated. * * Since: 2.4 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_can_activate_accel (GtkWidget *widget, guint signal_id) { gboolean can_activate = FALSE; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[CAN_ACTIVATE_ACCEL], 0, signal_id, &can_activate); return can_activate; } typedef struct { GClosure closure; guint signal_id; } AccelClosure; static void closure_accel_activate (GClosure *closure, GValue *return_value, guint n_param_values, const GValue *param_values, gpointer invocation_hint, gpointer marshal_data) { AccelClosure *aclosure = (AccelClosure*) closure; gboolean can_activate = gtk_widget_can_activate_accel (closure->data, aclosure->signal_id); if (can_activate) g_signal_emit (closure->data, aclosure->signal_id, 0); /* whether accelerator was handled */ g_value_set_boolean (return_value, can_activate); } static void closures_destroy (gpointer data) { GSList *slist, *closures = data; for (slist = closures; slist; slist = slist->next) { g_closure_invalidate (slist->data); g_closure_unref (slist->data); } g_slist_free (closures); } static GClosure* widget_new_accel_closure (GtkWidget *widget, guint signal_id) { AccelClosure *aclosure; GClosure *closure = NULL; GSList *slist, *closures; closures = g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures); for (slist = closures; slist; slist = slist->next) if (!gtk_accel_group_from_accel_closure (slist->data)) { /* reuse this closure */ closure = slist->data; break; } if (!closure) { closure = g_closure_new_object (sizeof (AccelClosure), G_OBJECT (widget)); closures = g_slist_prepend (closures, g_closure_ref (closure)); g_closure_sink (closure); g_closure_set_marshal (closure, closure_accel_activate); } g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures, closures, closures_destroy); aclosure = (AccelClosure*) closure; g_assert (closure->data == widget); g_assert (closure->marshal == closure_accel_activate); aclosure->signal_id = signal_id; return closure; } /** * gtk_widget_add_accelerator * @widget: widget to install an accelerator on * @accel_signal: widget signal to emit on accelerator activation * @accel_group: accel group for this widget, added to its toplevel * @accel_key: GDK keyval of the accelerator * @accel_mods: modifier key combination of the accelerator * @accel_flags: flag accelerators, e.g. %GTK_ACCEL_VISIBLE * * Installs an accelerator for this @widget in @accel_group that causes * @accel_signal to be emitted if the accelerator is activated. * The @accel_group needs to be added to the widget's toplevel via * gtk_window_add_accel_group(), and the signal must be of type %G_RUN_ACTION. * Accelerators added through this function are not user changeable during * runtime. If you want to support accelerators that can be changed by the * user, use gtk_accel_map_add_entry() and gtk_widget_set_accel_path() or * gtk_menu_item_set_accel_path() instead. */ void gtk_widget_add_accelerator (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *accel_signal, GtkAccelGroup *accel_group, guint accel_key, GdkModifierType accel_mods, GtkAccelFlags accel_flags) { GClosure *closure; GSignalQuery query; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (accel_signal != NULL); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_ACCEL_GROUP (accel_group)); g_signal_query (g_signal_lookup (accel_signal, G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget)), &query); if (!query.signal_id || !(query.signal_flags & G_SIGNAL_ACTION) || query.return_type != G_TYPE_NONE || query.n_params) { /* hmm, should be elaborate enough */ g_warning (G_STRLOC ": widget `%s' has no activatable signal \"%s\" without arguments", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), accel_signal); return; } closure = widget_new_accel_closure (widget, query.signal_id); g_object_ref (widget); /* install the accelerator. since we don't map this onto an accel_path, * the accelerator will automatically be locked. */ gtk_accel_group_connect (accel_group, accel_key, accel_mods, accel_flags | GTK_ACCEL_LOCKED, closure); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED], 0); g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_remove_accelerator: * @widget: widget to install an accelerator on * @accel_group: accel group for this widget * @accel_key: GDK keyval of the accelerator * @accel_mods: modifier key combination of the accelerator * @returns: whether an accelerator was installed and could be removed * * Removes an accelerator from @widget, previously installed with * gtk_widget_add_accelerator(). */ gboolean gtk_widget_remove_accelerator (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAccelGroup *accel_group, guint accel_key, GdkModifierType accel_mods) { GtkAccelGroupEntry *ag_entry; GList *slist, *clist; guint n; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_ACCEL_GROUP (accel_group), FALSE); ag_entry = gtk_accel_group_query (accel_group, accel_key, accel_mods, &n); clist = gtk_widget_list_accel_closures (widget); for (slist = clist; slist; slist = slist->next) { guint i; for (i = 0; i < n; i++) if (slist->data == (gpointer) ag_entry[i].closure) { gboolean is_removed = gtk_accel_group_disconnect (accel_group, slist->data); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED], 0); g_list_free (clist); return is_removed; } } g_list_free (clist); g_warning (G_STRLOC ": no accelerator (%u,%u) installed in accel group (%p) for %s (%p)", accel_key, accel_mods, accel_group, G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); return FALSE; } /** * gtk_widget_list_accel_closures: * @widget: widget to list accelerator closures for * * Lists the closures used by @widget for accelerator group connections * with gtk_accel_group_connect_by_path() or gtk_accel_group_connect(). * The closures can be used to monitor accelerator changes on @widget, * by connecting to the @GtkAccelGroup::accel-changed signal of the * #GtkAccelGroup of a closure which can be found out with * gtk_accel_group_from_accel_closure(). * * Return value: (transfer container) (element-type GClosure): * a newly allocated #GList of closures */ GList* gtk_widget_list_accel_closures (GtkWidget *widget) { GSList *slist; GList *clist = NULL; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); for (slist = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures); slist; slist = slist->next) if (gtk_accel_group_from_accel_closure (slist->data)) clist = g_list_prepend (clist, slist->data); return clist; } typedef struct { GQuark path_quark; GtkAccelGroup *accel_group; GClosure *closure; } AccelPath; static void destroy_accel_path (gpointer data) { AccelPath *apath = data; gtk_accel_group_disconnect (apath->accel_group, apath->closure); /* closures_destroy takes care of unrefing the closure */ g_object_unref (apath->accel_group); g_slice_free (AccelPath, apath); } /** * gtk_widget_set_accel_path: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @accel_path: (allow-none): path used to look up the accelerator * @accel_group: (allow-none): a #GtkAccelGroup. * * Given an accelerator group, @accel_group, and an accelerator path, * @accel_path, sets up an accelerator in @accel_group so whenever the * key binding that is defined for @accel_path is pressed, @widget * will be activated. This removes any accelerators (for any * accelerator group) installed by previous calls to * gtk_widget_set_accel_path(). Associating accelerators with * paths allows them to be modified by the user and the modifications * to be saved for future use. (See gtk_accel_map_save().) * * This function is a low level function that would most likely * be used by a menu creation system like #GtkUIManager. If you * use #GtkUIManager, setting up accelerator paths will be done * automatically. * * Even when you you aren't using #GtkUIManager, if you only want to * set up accelerators on menu items gtk_menu_item_set_accel_path() * provides a somewhat more convenient interface. * * Note that @accel_path string will be stored in a #GQuark. Therefore, if you * pass a static string, you can save some memory by interning it first with * g_intern_static_string(). **/ void gtk_widget_set_accel_path (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *accel_path, GtkAccelGroup *accel_group) { AccelPath *apath; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal != 0); if (accel_path) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_ACCEL_GROUP (accel_group)); g_return_if_fail (_gtk_accel_path_is_valid (accel_path)); gtk_accel_map_add_entry (accel_path, 0, 0); apath = g_slice_new (AccelPath); apath->accel_group = g_object_ref (accel_group); apath->path_quark = g_quark_from_string (accel_path); apath->closure = widget_new_accel_closure (widget, GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal); } else apath = NULL; /* also removes possible old settings */ g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_path, apath, destroy_accel_path); if (apath) gtk_accel_group_connect_by_path (apath->accel_group, g_quark_to_string (apath->path_quark), apath->closure); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED], 0); } const gchar* _gtk_widget_get_accel_path (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean *locked) { AccelPath *apath; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); apath = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_path); if (locked) *locked = apath ? gtk_accel_group_get_is_locked (apath->accel_group) : TRUE; return apath ? g_quark_to_string (apath->path_quark) : NULL; } /** * gtk_widget_mnemonic_activate: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @group_cycling: %TRUE if there are other widgets with the same mnemonic * * Emits the #GtkWidget::mnemonic-activate signal. * * The default handler for this signal activates the @widget if * @group_cycling is %FALSE, and just grabs the focus if @group_cycling * is %TRUE. * * Returns: %TRUE if the signal has been handled */ gboolean gtk_widget_mnemonic_activate (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean group_cycling) { gboolean handled; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); group_cycling = group_cycling != FALSE; if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) handled = TRUE; else g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[MNEMONIC_ACTIVATE], 0, group_cycling, &handled); return handled; } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_mnemonic_activate (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean group_cycling) { if (!group_cycling && GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal) gtk_widget_activate (widget); else if (gtk_widget_get_can_focus (widget)) gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget); else { g_warning ("widget `%s' isn't suitable for mnemonic activation", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget)); gtk_widget_error_bell (widget); } return TRUE; } static const cairo_user_data_key_t event_key; GdkEventExpose * _gtk_cairo_get_event (cairo_t *cr) { g_return_val_if_fail (cr != NULL, NULL); return cairo_get_user_data (cr, &event_key); } static void gtk_cairo_set_event (cairo_t *cr, GdkEventExpose *event) { cairo_set_user_data (cr, &event_key, event, NULL); } /** * gtk_cairo_should_draw_window: * @cr: a cairo context * @window: the window to check. @window may not be an input-only * window. * * This function is supposed to be called in #GtkWidget::draw * implementations for widgets that support multiple windows. * @cr must be untransformed from invoking of the draw function. * This function will return %TRUE if the contents of the given * @window are supposed to be drawn and %FALSE otherwise. Note * that when the drawing was not initiated by the windowing * system this function will return %TRUE for all windows, so * you need to draw the bottommost window first. Also, do not * use "else if" statements to check which window should be drawn. * * Returns: %TRUE if @window should be drawn * * Since: 3.0 **/ gboolean gtk_cairo_should_draw_window (cairo_t *cr, GdkWindow *window) { GdkEventExpose *event; g_return_val_if_fail (cr != NULL, FALSE); g_return_val_if_fail (GDK_IS_WINDOW (window), FALSE); event = _gtk_cairo_get_event (cr); return event == NULL || event->window == window; } static gboolean gtk_widget_get_clip_draw (GtkWidget *widget) { /* labels are not clipped, because clipping them would cause * mnemonics to not appear on characters that go beyond the * baseline. * https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=648570 */ if (GTK_IS_LABEL (widget)) return FALSE; return TRUE; } /* code shared by gtk_container_propagate_draw() and * gtk_widget_draw() */ void _gtk_widget_draw_internal (GtkWidget *widget, cairo_t *cr, gboolean clip_to_size) { GtkStyleContext *context; if (!gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget)) return; clip_to_size &= gtk_widget_get_clip_draw (widget); if (clip_to_size) { cairo_rectangle (cr, 0, 0, widget->priv->allocation.width, widget->priv->allocation.height); cairo_clip (cr); } if (gdk_cairo_get_clip_rectangle (cr, NULL)) { gboolean result; g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[DRAW], 0, cr, &result); } context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget); _gtk_style_context_coalesce_animation_areas (context, widget); } /** * gtk_widget_draw: * @widget: the widget to draw. It must be drawable (see * gtk_widget_is_drawable()) and a size must have been allocated. * @cr: a cairo context to draw to * * Draws @widget to @cr. The top left corner of the widget will be * drawn to the currently set origin point of @cr. * * You should pass a cairo context as @cr argument that is in an * original state. Otherwise the resulting drawing is undefined. For * example changing the operator using cairo_set_operator() or the * line width using cairo_set_line_width() might have unwanted side * effects. * You may however change the context's transform matrix - like with * cairo_scale(), cairo_translate() or cairo_set_matrix() and clip * region with cairo_clip() prior to calling this function. Also, it * is fine to modify the context with cairo_save() and * cairo_push_group() prior to calling this function. * * Special purpose widgets may contain special code for * rendering to the screen and might appear differently on screen * and when rendered using gtk_widget_draw(). * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_draw (GtkWidget *widget, cairo_t *cr) { GdkEventExpose *tmp_event; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (!widget->priv->alloc_needed); g_return_if_fail (cr != NULL); cairo_save (cr); /* We have to reset the event here so that draw functions can call * gtk_widget_draw() on random other widgets and get the desired * effect: Drawing all contents, not just the current window. */ tmp_event = _gtk_cairo_get_event (cr); gtk_cairo_set_event (cr, NULL); _gtk_widget_draw_internal (widget, cr, TRUE); gtk_cairo_set_event (cr, tmp_event); cairo_restore (cr); } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_key_press_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventKey *event) { return gtk_bindings_activate_event (G_OBJECT (widget), event); } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_key_release_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventKey *event) { return gtk_bindings_activate_event (G_OBJECT (widget), event); } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_focus_in_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventFocus *event) { gtk_widget_queue_shallow_draw (widget); return FALSE; } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_focus_out_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventFocus *event) { gtk_widget_queue_shallow_draw (widget); return FALSE; } #define WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT(widget, event) \ (event->type == GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE || gtk_widget_get_realized(widget)) /** * gtk_widget_event: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @event: a #GdkEvent * * Rarely-used function. This function is used to emit * the event signals on a widget (those signals should never * be emitted without using this function to do so). * If you want to synthesize an event though, don't use this function; * instead, use gtk_main_do_event() so the event will behave as if * it were in the event queue. Don't synthesize expose events; instead, * use gdk_window_invalidate_rect() to invalidate a region of the * window. * * Return value: return from the event signal emission (%TRUE if * the event was handled) **/ gboolean gtk_widget_event (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEvent *event) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), TRUE); g_return_val_if_fail (WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event), TRUE); if (event->type == GDK_EXPOSE) { g_warning ("Events of type GDK_EXPOSE cannot be synthesized. To get " "the same effect, call gdk_window_invalidate_rect/region(), " "followed by gdk_window_process_updates()."); return TRUE; } return gtk_widget_event_internal (widget, event); } /* Returns TRUE if a translation should be done */ gboolean _gtk_widget_get_translation_to_window (GtkWidget *widget, GdkWindow *window, int *x, int *y) { GdkWindow *w, *widget_window; if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) { *x = -widget->priv->allocation.x; *y = -widget->priv->allocation.y; } else { *x = 0; *y = 0; } widget_window = gtk_widget_get_window (widget); for (w = window; w && w != widget_window; w = gdk_window_get_parent (w)) { int wx, wy; gdk_window_get_position (w, &wx, &wy); *x += wx; *y += wy; } if (w == NULL) { *x = 0; *y = 0; return FALSE; } return TRUE; } /** * gtk_cairo_transform_to_window: * @cr: the cairo context to transform * @widget: the widget the context is currently centered for * @window: the window to transform the context to * * Transforms the given cairo context @cr that from @widget-relative * coordinates to @window-relative coordinates. * If the @widget's window is not an ancestor of @window, no * modification will be applied. * * This is the inverse to the transformation GTK applies when * preparing an expose event to be emitted with the #GtkWidget::draw * signal. It is intended to help porting multiwindow widgets from * GTK+ 2 to the rendering architecture of GTK+ 3. * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_cairo_transform_to_window (cairo_t *cr, GtkWidget *widget, GdkWindow *window) { int x, y; g_return_if_fail (cr != NULL); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GDK_IS_WINDOW (window)); if (_gtk_widget_get_translation_to_window (widget, window, &x, &y)) cairo_translate (cr, x, y); } /** * gtk_widget_send_expose: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @event: a expose #GdkEvent * * Very rarely-used function. This function is used to emit * an expose event on a widget. This function is not normally used * directly. The only time it is used is when propagating an expose * event to a child %NO_WINDOW widget, and that is normally done * using gtk_container_propagate_draw(). * * If you want to force an area of a window to be redrawn, * use gdk_window_invalidate_rect() or gdk_window_invalidate_region(). * To cause the redraw to be done immediately, follow that call * with a call to gdk_window_process_updates(). * * Return value: return from the event signal emission (%TRUE if * the event was handled) **/ gint gtk_widget_send_expose (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEvent *event) { gboolean result = FALSE; cairo_t *cr; int x, y; gboolean do_clip; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), TRUE); g_return_val_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget), TRUE); g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL, TRUE); g_return_val_if_fail (event->type == GDK_EXPOSE, TRUE); cr = gdk_cairo_create (event->expose.window); gtk_cairo_set_event (cr, &event->expose); gdk_cairo_region (cr, event->expose.region); cairo_clip (cr); do_clip = _gtk_widget_get_translation_to_window (widget, event->expose.window, &x, &y); cairo_translate (cr, -x, -y); _gtk_widget_draw_internal (widget, cr, do_clip); /* unset here, so if someone keeps a reference to cr we * don't leak the window. */ gtk_cairo_set_event (cr, NULL); cairo_destroy (cr); return result; } static gboolean event_window_is_still_viewable (GdkEvent *event) { /* Check that we think the event's window is viewable before * delivering the event, to prevent suprises. We do this here * at the last moment, since the event may have been queued * up behind other events, held over a recursive main loop, etc. */ switch (event->type) { case GDK_EXPOSE: case GDK_MOTION_NOTIFY: case GDK_BUTTON_PRESS: case GDK_2BUTTON_PRESS: case GDK_3BUTTON_PRESS: case GDK_KEY_PRESS: case GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY: case GDK_PROXIMITY_IN: case GDK_SCROLL: return event->any.window && gdk_window_is_viewable (event->any.window); #if 0 /* The following events are the second half of paired events; * we always deliver them to deal with widgets that clean up * on the second half. */ case GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE: case GDK_KEY_RELEASE: case GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY: case GDK_PROXIMITY_OUT: #endif default: /* Remaining events would make sense on an not-viewable window, * or don't have an associated window. */ return TRUE; } } static gint gtk_widget_event_internal (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEvent *event) { gboolean return_val = FALSE; /* We check only once for is-still-visible; if someone * hides the window in on of the signals on the widget, * they are responsible for returning TRUE to terminate * handling. */ if (!event_window_is_still_viewable (event)) return TRUE; g_object_ref (widget); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[EVENT], 0, event, &return_val); return_val |= !WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event); if (!return_val) { gint signal_num; switch (event->type) { case GDK_EXPOSE: case GDK_NOTHING: signal_num = -1; break; case GDK_BUTTON_PRESS: case GDK_2BUTTON_PRESS: case GDK_3BUTTON_PRESS: signal_num = BUTTON_PRESS_EVENT; break; case GDK_SCROLL: signal_num = SCROLL_EVENT; break; case GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE: signal_num = BUTTON_RELEASE_EVENT; break; case GDK_MOTION_NOTIFY: signal_num = MOTION_NOTIFY_EVENT; break; case GDK_DELETE: signal_num = DELETE_EVENT; break; case GDK_DESTROY: signal_num = DESTROY_EVENT; _gtk_tooltip_hide (widget); break; case GDK_KEY_PRESS: signal_num = KEY_PRESS_EVENT; break; case GDK_KEY_RELEASE: signal_num = KEY_RELEASE_EVENT; break; case GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY: signal_num = ENTER_NOTIFY_EVENT; break; case GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY: signal_num = LEAVE_NOTIFY_EVENT; break; case GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE: signal_num = event->focus_change.in ? FOCUS_IN_EVENT : FOCUS_OUT_EVENT; if (event->focus_change.in) _gtk_tooltip_focus_in (widget); else _gtk_tooltip_focus_out (widget); break; case GDK_CONFIGURE: signal_num = CONFIGURE_EVENT; break; case GDK_MAP: signal_num = MAP_EVENT; break; case GDK_UNMAP: signal_num = UNMAP_EVENT; break; case GDK_WINDOW_STATE: signal_num = WINDOW_STATE_EVENT; break; case GDK_PROPERTY_NOTIFY: signal_num = PROPERTY_NOTIFY_EVENT; break; case GDK_SELECTION_CLEAR: signal_num = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT; break; case GDK_SELECTION_REQUEST: signal_num = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT; break; case GDK_SELECTION_NOTIFY: signal_num = SELECTION_NOTIFY_EVENT; break; case GDK_PROXIMITY_IN: signal_num = PROXIMITY_IN_EVENT; break; case GDK_PROXIMITY_OUT: signal_num = PROXIMITY_OUT_EVENT; break; case GDK_VISIBILITY_NOTIFY: signal_num = VISIBILITY_NOTIFY_EVENT; break; case GDK_GRAB_BROKEN: signal_num = GRAB_BROKEN_EVENT; break; case GDK_DAMAGE: signal_num = DAMAGE_EVENT; break; default: g_warning ("gtk_widget_event(): unhandled event type: %d", event->type); signal_num = -1; break; } if (signal_num != -1) g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[signal_num], 0, event, &return_val); } if (WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event)) g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[EVENT_AFTER], 0, event); else return_val = TRUE; g_object_unref (widget); return return_val; } /** * gtk_widget_activate: * @widget: a #GtkWidget that's activatable * * For widgets that can be "activated" (buttons, menu items, etc.) * this function activates them. Activation is what happens when you * press Enter on a widget during key navigation. If @widget isn't * activatable, the function returns %FALSE. * * Return value: %TRUE if the widget was activatable **/ gboolean gtk_widget_activate (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); if (WIDGET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal) { /* FIXME: we should eventually check the signals signature here */ g_signal_emit (widget, WIDGET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal, 0); return TRUE; } else return FALSE; } static void gtk_widget_reparent_subwindows (GtkWidget *widget, GdkWindow *new_window) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) { GList *children = gdk_window_get_children (priv->window); GList *tmp_list; for (tmp_list = children; tmp_list; tmp_list = tmp_list->next) { GdkWindow *window = tmp_list->data; gpointer child; gdk_window_get_user_data (window, &child); while (child && child != widget) child = ((GtkWidget*) child)->priv->parent; if (child) gdk_window_reparent (window, new_window, 0, 0); } g_list_free (children); } else { GdkWindow *parent; GList *tmp_list, *children; parent = gdk_window_get_parent (priv->window); if (parent == NULL) gdk_window_reparent (priv->window, new_window, 0, 0); else { children = gdk_window_get_children (parent); for (tmp_list = children; tmp_list; tmp_list = tmp_list->next) { GdkWindow *window = tmp_list->data; gpointer child; gdk_window_get_user_data (window, &child); if (child == widget) gdk_window_reparent (window, new_window, 0, 0); } g_list_free (children); } } } static void gtk_widget_reparent_fixup_child (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer client_data) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; g_assert (client_data != NULL); if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) { if (priv->window) g_object_unref (priv->window); priv->window = (GdkWindow*) client_data; if (priv->window) g_object_ref (priv->window); if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), gtk_widget_reparent_fixup_child, client_data); } } /** * gtk_widget_reparent: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @new_parent: a #GtkContainer to move the widget into * * Moves a widget from one #GtkContainer to another, handling reference * count issues to avoid destroying the widget. **/ void gtk_widget_reparent (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *new_parent) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (new_parent)); priv = widget->priv; g_return_if_fail (priv->parent != NULL); if (priv->parent != new_parent) { /* First try to see if we can get away without unrealizing * the widget as we reparent it. if so we set a flag so * that gtk_widget_unparent doesn't unrealize widget */ if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget) && gtk_widget_get_realized (new_parent)) priv->in_reparent = TRUE; g_object_ref (widget); gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (priv->parent), widget); gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (new_parent), widget); g_object_unref (widget); if (priv->in_reparent) { priv->in_reparent = FALSE; gtk_widget_reparent_subwindows (widget, gtk_widget_get_parent_window (widget)); gtk_widget_reparent_fixup_child (widget, gtk_widget_get_parent_window (widget)); } g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "parent"); } } /** * gtk_widget_intersect: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @area: a rectangle * @intersection: rectangle to store intersection of @widget and @area * * Computes the intersection of a @widget's area and @area, storing * the intersection in @intersection, and returns %TRUE if there was * an intersection. @intersection may be %NULL if you're only * interested in whether there was an intersection. * * Return value: %TRUE if there was an intersection **/ gboolean gtk_widget_intersect (GtkWidget *widget, const GdkRectangle *area, GdkRectangle *intersection) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GdkRectangle *dest; GdkRectangle tmp; gint return_val; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_return_val_if_fail (area != NULL, FALSE); priv = widget->priv; if (intersection) dest = intersection; else dest = &tmp; return_val = gdk_rectangle_intersect (&priv->allocation, area, dest); if (return_val && intersection && gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) { intersection->x -= priv->allocation.x; intersection->y -= priv->allocation.y; } return return_val; } /** * gtk_widget_region_intersect: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @region: a #cairo_region_t, in the same coordinate system as * @widget->allocation. That is, relative to @widget->window * for %NO_WINDOW widgets; relative to the parent window * of @widget->window for widgets with their own window. * @returns: A newly allocated region holding the intersection of @widget * and @region. The coordinates of the return value are * relative to @widget->window for %NO_WINDOW widgets, and * relative to the parent window of @widget->window for * widgets with their own window. * * Computes the intersection of a @widget's area and @region, returning * the intersection. The result may be empty, use cairo_region_is_empty() to * check. **/ cairo_region_t * gtk_widget_region_intersect (GtkWidget *widget, const cairo_region_t *region) { GdkRectangle rect; cairo_region_t *dest; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); g_return_val_if_fail (region != NULL, NULL); gtk_widget_get_allocation (widget, &rect); dest = cairo_region_create_rectangle (&rect); cairo_region_intersect (dest, region); return dest; } /** * _gtk_widget_grab_notify: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @was_grabbed: whether a grab is now in effect * * Emits the #GtkWidget::grab-notify signal on @widget. * * Since: 2.6 **/ void _gtk_widget_grab_notify (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean was_grabbed) { g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[GRAB_NOTIFY], 0, was_grabbed); } /** * gtk_widget_grab_focus: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Causes @widget to have the keyboard focus for the #GtkWindow it's * inside. @widget must be a focusable widget, such as a #GtkEntry; * something like #GtkFrame won't work. * * More precisely, it must have the %GTK_CAN_FOCUS flag set. Use * gtk_widget_set_can_focus() to modify that flag. * * The widget also needs to be realized and mapped. This is indicated by the * related signals. Grabbing the focus immediately after creating the widget * will likely fail and cause critical warnings. **/ void gtk_widget_grab_focus (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) return; g_object_ref (widget); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[GRAB_FOCUS], 0); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "has-focus"); g_object_unref (widget); } static void reset_focus_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data) { if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) { GtkContainer *container; container = GTK_CONTAINER (widget); gtk_container_set_focus_child (container, NULL); gtk_container_foreach (container, reset_focus_recurse, NULL); } } static void gtk_widget_real_grab_focus (GtkWidget *focus_widget) { if (gtk_widget_get_can_focus (focus_widget)) { GtkWidget *toplevel; GtkWidget *widget; /* clear the current focus setting, break if the current widget * is the focus widget's parent, since containers above that will * be set by the next loop. */ toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (focus_widget); if (gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel) && GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) { widget = gtk_window_get_focus (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel)); if (widget == focus_widget) { /* We call _gtk_window_internal_set_focus() here so that the * toplevel window can request the focus if necessary. * This is needed when the toplevel is a GtkPlug */ if (!gtk_widget_has_focus (widget)) _gtk_window_internal_set_focus (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), focus_widget); return; } if (widget) { while (widget->priv->parent && widget->priv->parent != focus_widget->priv->parent) { widget = widget->priv->parent; gtk_container_set_focus_child (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), NULL); } } } else if (toplevel != focus_widget) { /* gtk_widget_grab_focus() operates on a tree without window... * actually, this is very questionable behaviour. */ gtk_container_foreach (GTK_CONTAINER (toplevel), reset_focus_recurse, NULL); } /* now propagate the new focus up the widget tree and finally * set it on the window */ widget = focus_widget; while (widget->priv->parent) { gtk_container_set_focus_child (GTK_CONTAINER (widget->priv->parent), widget); widget = widget->priv->parent; } if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (widget)) _gtk_window_internal_set_focus (GTK_WINDOW (widget), focus_widget); } } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_query_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, gint x, gint y, gboolean keyboard_tip, GtkTooltip *tooltip) { gchar *tooltip_markup; gboolean has_tooltip; tooltip_markup = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_markup); has_tooltip = GPOINTER_TO_UINT (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_has_tooltip)); if (has_tooltip && tooltip_markup) { gtk_tooltip_set_markup (tooltip, tooltip_markup); return TRUE; } return FALSE; } static void gtk_widget_real_style_updated (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (priv->style != NULL && priv->style != gtk_widget_get_default_style ()) { /* Trigger ::style-set for old * widgets not listening to this */ g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[STYLE_SET], 0, widget->priv->style); } if (widget->priv->context) { if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget) && gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) gtk_style_context_set_background (widget->priv->context, widget->priv->window); } if (widget->priv->anchored) gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_show_help (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidgetHelpType help_type) { if (help_type == GTK_WIDGET_HELP_TOOLTIP) { _gtk_tooltip_toggle_keyboard_mode (widget); return TRUE; } else return FALSE; } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_focus (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction) { if (!gtk_widget_get_can_focus (widget)) return FALSE; if (!gtk_widget_is_focus (widget)) { gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget); return TRUE; } else return FALSE; } static void gtk_widget_real_move_focus (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction) { GtkWidget *toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (widget != toplevel && GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) { g_signal_emit (toplevel, widget_signals[MOVE_FOCUS], 0, direction); } } static gboolean gtk_widget_real_keynav_failed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction) { gboolean cursor_only; switch (direction) { case GTK_DIR_TAB_FORWARD: case GTK_DIR_TAB_BACKWARD: return FALSE; case GTK_DIR_UP: case GTK_DIR_DOWN: case GTK_DIR_LEFT: case GTK_DIR_RIGHT: g_object_get (gtk_widget_get_settings (widget), "gtk-keynav-cursor-only", &cursor_only, NULL); if (cursor_only) return FALSE; break; } gtk_widget_error_bell (widget); return TRUE; } /** * gtk_widget_set_can_focus: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @can_focus: whether or not @widget can own the input focus. * * Specifies whether @widget can own the input focus. See * gtk_widget_grab_focus() for actually setting the input focus on a * widget. * * Since: 2.18 **/ void gtk_widget_set_can_focus (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean can_focus) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (widget->priv->can_focus != can_focus) { widget->priv->can_focus = can_focus; gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "can-focus"); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_can_focus: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget can own the input focus. See * gtk_widget_set_can_focus(). * * Return value: %TRUE if @widget can own the input focus, %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_can_focus (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->can_focus; } /** * gtk_widget_has_focus: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines if the widget has the global input focus. See * gtk_widget_is_focus() for the difference between having the global * input focus, and only having the focus within a toplevel. * * Return value: %TRUE if the widget has the global input focus. * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_has_focus (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->has_focus; } /** * gtk_widget_is_focus: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines if the widget is the focus widget within its * toplevel. (This does not mean that the %HAS_FOCUS flag is * necessarily set; %HAS_FOCUS will only be set if the * toplevel widget additionally has the global input focus.) * * Return value: %TRUE if the widget is the focus widget. **/ gboolean gtk_widget_is_focus (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *toplevel; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) return widget == gtk_window_get_focus (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel)); else return FALSE; } /** * gtk_widget_set_can_default: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @can_default: whether or not @widget can be a default widget. * * Specifies whether @widget can be a default widget. See * gtk_widget_grab_default() for details about the meaning of * "default". * * Since: 2.18 **/ void gtk_widget_set_can_default (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean can_default) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (widget->priv->can_default != can_default) { widget->priv->can_default = can_default; gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "can-default"); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_can_default: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget can be a default widget. See * gtk_widget_set_can_default(). * * Return value: %TRUE if @widget can be a default widget, %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_can_default (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->can_default; } /** * gtk_widget_has_default: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget is the current default widget within its * toplevel. See gtk_widget_set_can_default(). * * Return value: %TRUE if @widget is the current default widget within * its toplevel, %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.18 */ gboolean gtk_widget_has_default (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->has_default; } void _gtk_widget_set_has_default (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean has_default) { widget->priv->has_default = has_default; } /** * gtk_widget_grab_default: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Causes @widget to become the default widget. @widget must have the * %GTK_CAN_DEFAULT flag set; typically you have to set this flag * yourself by calling gtk_widget_set_can_default (@widget, * %TRUE). The default widget is activated when * the user presses Enter in a window. Default widgets must be * activatable, that is, gtk_widget_activate() should affect them. Note * that #GtkEntry widgets require the "activates-default" property * set to %TRUE before they activate the default widget when Enter * is pressed and the #GtkEntry is focused. **/ void gtk_widget_grab_default (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *window; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_can_default (widget)); window = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (window && gtk_widget_is_toplevel (window)) gtk_window_set_default (GTK_WINDOW (window), widget); else g_warning (G_STRLOC ": widget not within a GtkWindow"); } /** * gtk_widget_set_receives_default: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @receives_default: whether or not @widget can be a default widget. * * Specifies whether @widget will be treated as the default widget * within its toplevel when it has the focus, even if another widget * is the default. * * See gtk_widget_grab_default() for details about the meaning of * "default". * * Since: 2.18 **/ void gtk_widget_set_receives_default (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean receives_default) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (widget->priv->receives_default != receives_default) { widget->priv->receives_default = receives_default; g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "receives-default"); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_receives_default: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget is alyways treated as default widget * withing its toplevel when it has the focus, even if another widget * is the default. * * See gtk_widget_set_receives_default(). * * Return value: %TRUE if @widget acts as default widget when focussed, * %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_receives_default (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->receives_default; } /** * gtk_widget_has_grab: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether the widget is currently grabbing events, so it * is the only widget receiving input events (keyboard and mouse). * * See also gtk_grab_add(). * * Return value: %TRUE if the widget is in the grab_widgets stack * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_has_grab (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->has_grab; } void _gtk_widget_set_has_grab (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean has_grab) { widget->priv->has_grab = has_grab; } /** * gtk_widget_device_is_shadowed: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @device: a #GdkDevice * * Returns %TRUE if @device has been shadowed by a GTK+ * device grab on another widget, so it would stop sending * events to @widget. This may be used in the * #GtkWidget::grab-notify signal to check for specific * devices. See gtk_device_grab_add(). * * Returns: %TRUE if there is an ongoing grab on @device * by another #GtkWidget than @widget. * * Since: 3.0 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_device_is_shadowed (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device) { GtkWindowGroup *group; GtkWidget *grab_widget, *toplevel; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_return_val_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device), FALSE); if (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) return TRUE; toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) group = gtk_window_get_group (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel)); else group = gtk_window_get_group (NULL); grab_widget = gtk_window_group_get_current_device_grab (group, device); /* Widget not inside the hierarchy of grab_widget */ if (grab_widget && widget != grab_widget && !gtk_widget_is_ancestor (widget, grab_widget)) return TRUE; grab_widget = gtk_window_group_get_current_grab (group); if (grab_widget && widget != grab_widget && !gtk_widget_is_ancestor (widget, grab_widget)) return TRUE; return FALSE; } /** * gtk_widget_set_name: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @name: name for the widget * * Widgets can be named, which allows you to refer to them from a * CSS file. You can apply a style to widgets with a particular name * in the CSS file. See the documentation for the CSS syntax (on the * same page as the docs for #GtkStyleContext). * * Note that the CSS syntax has certain special characters to delimit * and represent elements in a selector (period, #, >, *...), * so using these will make your widget impossible to match by name. * Any combination of alphanumeric symbols, dashes and underscores will * suffice. **/ void gtk_widget_set_name (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *name) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; gchar *new_name; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; new_name = g_strdup (name); g_free (priv->name); priv->name = new_name; gtk_widget_reset_style (widget); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "name"); } /** * gtk_widget_get_name: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Retrieves the name of a widget. See gtk_widget_set_name() for the * significance of widget names. * * Return value: name of the widget. This string is owned by GTK+ and * should not be modified or freed **/ G_CONST_RETURN gchar* gtk_widget_get_name (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); priv = widget->priv; if (priv->name) return priv->name; return G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget); } static void _gtk_widget_update_state_flags (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateFlags flags, guint operation) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; priv = widget->priv; /* Handle insensitive first, since it is propagated * differently throughout the widget hierarchy. */ if ((priv->state_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && (flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && (operation == STATE_CHANGE_UNSET)) gtk_widget_set_sensitive (widget, TRUE); else if (!(priv->state_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && (flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && (operation != STATE_CHANGE_UNSET)) gtk_widget_set_sensitive (widget, FALSE); else if ((priv->state_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && !(flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && (operation == STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE)) gtk_widget_set_sensitive (widget, TRUE); if (operation != STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE) flags &= ~(GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE); if (flags != 0 || operation == STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE) { GtkStateData data; data.flags = flags; data.operation = operation; data.use_forall = FALSE; gtk_widget_propagate_state (widget, &data); gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); } } /** * gtk_widget_set_state_flags: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @flags: State flags to turn on * @clear: Whether to clear state before turning on @flags * * This function is for use in widget implementations. Turns on flag * values in the current widget state (insensitive, prelighted, etc.). * * It is worth mentioning that any other state than %GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE, * will be propagated down to all non-internal children if @widget is a * #GtkContainer, while %GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE itself will be propagated * down to all #GtkContainer children by different means than turning on the * state flag down the hierarchy, both gtk_widget_get_state_flags() and * gtk_widget_is_sensitive() will make use of these. * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_set_state_flags (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateFlags flags, gboolean clear) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if ((!clear && (widget->priv->state_flags & flags) == flags) || (clear && widget->priv->state_flags == flags)) return; if (clear) _gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, flags, STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE); else _gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, flags, STATE_CHANGE_SET); } /** * gtk_widget_unset_state_flags: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @flags: State flags to turn off * * This function is for use in widget implementations. Turns off flag * values for the current widget state (insensitive, prelighted, etc.). * See gtk_widget_set_state_flags(). * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_unset_state_flags (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateFlags flags) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if ((widget->priv->state_flags & flags) == 0) return; _gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, flags, STATE_CHANGE_UNSET); } /** * gtk_widget_get_state_flags: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the widget state as a flag set. It is worth mentioning * that the effective %GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE state will be * returned, that is, also based on parent insensitivity, even if * @widget itself is sensitive. * * Returns: The state flags for widget * * Since: 3.0 **/ GtkStateFlags gtk_widget_get_state_flags (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkStateFlags flags; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); flags = widget->priv->state_flags; if (gtk_widget_has_focus (widget)) flags |= GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED; return flags; } /** * gtk_widget_set_state: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @state: new state for @widget * * This function is for use in widget implementations. Sets the state * of a widget (insensitive, prelighted, etc.) Usually you should set * the state using wrapper functions such as gtk_widget_set_sensitive(). * * Deprecated: 3.0. Use gtk_widget_set_state_flags() instead. **/ void gtk_widget_set_state (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateType state) { GtkStateFlags flags; if (state == gtk_widget_get_state (widget)) return; switch (state) { case GTK_STATE_ACTIVE: flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE; break; case GTK_STATE_PRELIGHT: flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT; break; case GTK_STATE_SELECTED: flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_SELECTED; break; case GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE: flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE; break; case GTK_STATE_INCONSISTENT: flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_INCONSISTENT; break; case GTK_STATE_FOCUSED: flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED; break; case GTK_STATE_NORMAL: default: flags = 0; break; } _gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, flags, STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE); } /** * gtk_widget_get_state: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the widget's state. See gtk_widget_set_state(). * * Returns: the state of @widget. * * Since: 2.18 * * Deprecated: 3.0. Use gtk_widget_get_state_flags() instead. */ GtkStateType gtk_widget_get_state (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkStateFlags flags; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_STATE_NORMAL); flags = gtk_widget_get_state_flags (widget); if (flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) return GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE; else if (flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE) return GTK_STATE_ACTIVE; else if (flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_SELECTED) return GTK_STATE_SELECTED; else if (flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT) return GTK_STATE_PRELIGHT; else return GTK_STATE_NORMAL; } /** * gtk_widget_set_visible: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @visible: whether the widget should be shown or not * * Sets the visibility state of @widget. Note that setting this to * %TRUE doesn't mean the widget is actually viewable, see * gtk_widget_get_visible(). * * This function simply calls gtk_widget_show() or gtk_widget_hide() * but is nicer to use when the visibility of the widget depends on * some condition. * * Since: 2.18 **/ void gtk_widget_set_visible (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean visible) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); if (visible != gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) { if (visible) gtk_widget_show (widget); else gtk_widget_hide (widget); } } void _gtk_widget_set_visible_flag (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean visible) { widget->priv->visible = visible; } /** * gtk_widget_get_visible: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether the widget is visible. Note that this doesn't * take into account whether the widget's parent is also visible * or the widget is obscured in any way. * * See gtk_widget_set_visible(). * * Return value: %TRUE if the widget is visible * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_visible (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->visible; } /** * gtk_widget_set_has_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @has_window: whether or not @widget has a window. * * Specifies whether @widget has a #GdkWindow of its own. Note that * all realized widgets have a non-%NULL "window" pointer * (gtk_widget_get_window() never returns a %NULL window when a widget * is realized), but for many of them it's actually the #GdkWindow of * one of its parent widgets. Widgets that do not create a %window for * themselves in #GtkWidget::realize must announce this by * calling this function with @has_window = %FALSE. * * This function should only be called by widget implementations, * and they should call it in their init() function. * * Since: 2.18 **/ void gtk_widget_set_has_window (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean has_window) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); widget->priv->no_window = !has_window; } /** * gtk_widget_get_has_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget has a #GdkWindow of its own. See * gtk_widget_set_has_window(). * * Return value: %TRUE if @widget has a window, %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_has_window (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return ! widget->priv->no_window; } /** * gtk_widget_is_toplevel: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget is a toplevel widget. * * Currently only #GtkWindow and #GtkInvisible (and out-of-process * #GtkPlugs) are toplevel widgets. Toplevel widgets have no parent * widget. * * Return value: %TRUE if @widget is a toplevel, %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_is_toplevel (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->toplevel; } void _gtk_widget_set_is_toplevel (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean is_toplevel) { widget->priv->toplevel = is_toplevel; } /** * gtk_widget_is_drawable: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget can be drawn to. A widget can be drawn * to if it is mapped and visible. * * Return value: %TRUE if @widget is drawable, %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_is_drawable (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) && gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)); } /** * gtk_widget_get_realized: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget is realized. * * Return value: %TRUE if @widget is realized, %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.20 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_realized (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->realized; } /** * gtk_widget_set_realized: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @realized: %TRUE to mark the widget as realized * * Marks the widget as being realized. * * This function should only ever be called in a derived widget's * "realize" or "unrealize" implementation. * * Since: 2.20 */ void gtk_widget_set_realized (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean realized) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); widget->priv->realized = realized; } /** * gtk_widget_get_mapped: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Whether the widget is mapped. * * Return value: %TRUE if the widget is mapped, %FALSE otherwise. * * Since: 2.20 */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_mapped (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->mapped; } /** * gtk_widget_set_mapped: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @mapped: %TRUE to mark the widget as mapped * * Marks the widget as being realized. * * This function should only ever be called in a derived widget's * "map" or "unmap" implementation. * * Since: 2.20 */ void gtk_widget_set_mapped (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean mapped) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); widget->priv->mapped = mapped; } /** * gtk_widget_set_app_paintable: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @app_paintable: %TRUE if the application will paint on the widget * * Sets whether the application intends to draw on the widget in * an #GtkWidget::draw handler. * * This is a hint to the widget and does not affect the behavior of * the GTK+ core; many widgets ignore this flag entirely. For widgets * that do pay attention to the flag, such as #GtkEventBox and #GtkWindow, * the effect is to suppress default themed drawing of the widget's * background. (Children of the widget will still be drawn.) The application * is then entirely responsible for drawing the widget background. * * Note that the background is still drawn when the widget is mapped. **/ void gtk_widget_set_app_paintable (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean app_paintable) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); app_paintable = (app_paintable != FALSE); if (widget->priv->app_paintable != app_paintable) { widget->priv->app_paintable = app_paintable; if (gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "app-paintable"); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_app_paintable: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether the application intends to draw on the widget in * an #GtkWidget::draw handler. * * See gtk_widget_set_app_paintable() * * Return value: %TRUE if the widget is app paintable * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_app_paintable (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->app_paintable; } /** * gtk_widget_set_double_buffered: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @double_buffered: %TRUE to double-buffer a widget * * Widgets are double buffered by default; you can use this function * to turn off the buffering. "Double buffered" simply means that * gdk_window_begin_paint_region() and gdk_window_end_paint() are called * automatically around expose events sent to the * widget. gdk_window_begin_paint() diverts all drawing to a widget's * window to an offscreen buffer, and gdk_window_end_paint() draws the * buffer to the screen. The result is that users see the window * update in one smooth step, and don't see individual graphics * primitives being rendered. * * In very simple terms, double buffered widgets don't flicker, * so you would only use this function to turn off double buffering * if you had special needs and really knew what you were doing. * * Note: if you turn off double-buffering, you have to handle * expose events, since even the clearing to the background color or * pixmap will not happen automatically (as it is done in * gdk_window_begin_paint()). **/ void gtk_widget_set_double_buffered (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean double_buffered) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); double_buffered = (double_buffered != FALSE); if (widget->priv->double_buffered != double_buffered) { widget->priv->double_buffered = double_buffered; g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "double-buffered"); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_double_buffered: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines whether the widget is double buffered. * * See gtk_widget_set_double_buffered() * * Return value: %TRUE if the widget is double buffered * * Since: 2.18 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_double_buffered (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->double_buffered; } /** * gtk_widget_set_redraw_on_allocate: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @redraw_on_allocate: if %TRUE, the entire widget will be redrawn * when it is allocated to a new size. Otherwise, only the * new portion of the widget will be redrawn. * * Sets whether the entire widget is queued for drawing when its size * allocation changes. By default, this setting is %TRUE and * the entire widget is redrawn on every size change. If your widget * leaves the upper left unchanged when made bigger, turning this * setting off will improve performance. * Note that for %NO_WINDOW widgets setting this flag to %FALSE turns * off all allocation on resizing: the widget will not even redraw if * its position changes; this is to allow containers that don't draw * anything to avoid excess invalidations. If you set this flag on a * %NO_WINDOW widget that does draw on @widget->window, * you are responsible for invalidating both the old and new allocation * of the widget when the widget is moved and responsible for invalidating * regions newly when the widget increases size. **/ void gtk_widget_set_redraw_on_allocate (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean redraw_on_allocate) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); widget->priv->redraw_on_alloc = redraw_on_allocate; } /** * gtk_widget_set_sensitive: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @sensitive: %TRUE to make the widget sensitive * * Sets the sensitivity of a widget. A widget is sensitive if the user * can interact with it. Insensitive widgets are "grayed out" and the * user can't interact with them. Insensitive widgets are known as * "inactive", "disabled", or "ghosted" in some other toolkits. **/ void gtk_widget_set_sensitive (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean sensitive) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GtkStateData data; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; sensitive = (sensitive != FALSE); if (priv->sensitive == sensitive) return; data.flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE; if (sensitive) { priv->sensitive = TRUE; data.operation = STATE_CHANGE_UNSET; } else { priv->sensitive = FALSE; data.operation = STATE_CHANGE_SET; } data.use_forall = TRUE; gtk_widget_propagate_state (widget, &data); gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "sensitive"); } /** * gtk_widget_get_sensitive: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the widget's sensitivity (in the sense of returning * the value that has been set using gtk_widget_set_sensitive()). * * The effective sensitivity of a widget is however determined by both its * own and its parent widget's sensitivity. See gtk_widget_is_sensitive(). * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is sensitive * * Since: 2.18 */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_sensitive (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->sensitive; } /** * gtk_widget_is_sensitive: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the widget's effective sensitivity, which means * it is sensitive itself and also its parent widget is sensitive * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is effectively sensitive * * Since: 2.18 */ gboolean gtk_widget_is_sensitive (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return !(widget->priv->state_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE); } static void _gtk_widget_update_path (GtkWidget *widget) { if (widget->priv->path) { gtk_widget_path_free (widget->priv->path); widget->priv->path = NULL; } gtk_widget_get_path (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_set_parent: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @parent: parent container * * This function is useful only when implementing subclasses of * #GtkContainer. * Sets the container as the parent of @widget, and takes care of * some details such as updating the state and style of the child * to reflect its new location. The opposite function is * gtk_widget_unparent(). **/ void gtk_widget_set_parent (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *parent) { GtkStateFlags parent_flags; GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GtkStateData data; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (parent)); g_return_if_fail (widget != parent); priv = widget->priv; if (priv->parent != NULL) { g_warning ("Can't set a parent on widget which has a parent\n"); return; } if (gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) { g_warning ("Can't set a parent on a toplevel widget\n"); return; } /* keep this function in sync with gtk_menu_attach_to_widget() */ g_object_ref_sink (widget); gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); priv->parent = parent; parent_flags = gtk_widget_get_state_flags (parent); /* Merge both old state and current parent state, * making sure to only propagate the right states */ data.flags = parent_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_PROPAGATE; data.flags |= priv->state_flags; data.operation = STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE; data.use_forall = gtk_widget_is_sensitive (parent) != gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget); gtk_widget_propagate_state (widget, &data); gtk_widget_reset_style (widget); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[PARENT_SET], 0, NULL); if (priv->parent->priv->anchored) _gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed (widget, NULL); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "parent"); /* Enforce realized/mapped invariants */ if (gtk_widget_get_realized (priv->parent)) gtk_widget_realize (widget); if (gtk_widget_get_visible (priv->parent) && gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) { if (gtk_widget_get_child_visible (widget) && gtk_widget_get_mapped (priv->parent)) gtk_widget_map (widget); gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); } /* child may cause parent's expand to change, if the child is * expanded. If child is not expanded, then it can't modify the * parent's expand. If the child becomes expanded later then it will * queue compute_expand then. This optimization plus defaulting * newly-constructed widgets to need_compute_expand=FALSE should * mean that initially building a widget tree doesn't have to keep * walking up setting need_compute_expand on parents over and over. * * We can't change a parent to need to expand unless we're visible. */ if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) && (priv->need_compute_expand || priv->computed_hexpand || priv->computed_vexpand)) { gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (parent); } gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_get_parent: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the parent container of @widget. * * Return value: (transfer none): the parent container of @widget, or %NULL **/ GtkWidget * gtk_widget_get_parent (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return widget->priv->parent; } /***************************************** * Widget styles * see docs/styles.txt *****************************************/ /** * gtk_widget_style_attach: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function attaches the widget's #GtkStyle to the widget's * #GdkWindow. It is a replacement for * * * widget->style = gtk_style_attach (widget->style, widget->window); * * * and should only ever be called in a derived widget's "realize" * implementation which does not chain up to its parent class' * "realize" implementation, because one of the parent classes * (finally #GtkWidget) would attach the style itself. * * Since: 2.20 * * Deprecated: 3.0. This step is unnecessary with #GtkStyleContext. **/ void gtk_widget_style_attach (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)); } /** * gtk_widget_has_rc_style: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Determines if the widget style has been looked up through the rc mechanism. * * Returns: %TRUE if the widget has been looked up through the rc * mechanism, %FALSE otherwise. * * Since: 2.20 * * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext instead **/ gboolean gtk_widget_has_rc_style (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->rc_style; } /** * gtk_widget_set_style: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @style: (allow-none): a #GtkStyle, or %NULL to remove the effect * of a previous call to gtk_widget_set_style() and go back to * the default style * * Used to set the #GtkStyle for a widget (@widget->style). Since * GTK 3, this function does nothing, the passed in style is ignored. * * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext instead */ void gtk_widget_set_style (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStyle *style) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); } /** * gtk_widget_ensure_style: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Ensures that @widget has a style (@widget->style). * * Not a very useful function; most of the time, if you * want the style, the widget is realized, and realized * widgets are guaranteed to have a style already. * * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext instead */ void gtk_widget_ensure_style (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; if (priv->style == gtk_widget_get_default_style ()) { g_object_unref (priv->style); priv->style = NULL; g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[STYLE_SET], 0, NULL); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_style: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Simply an accessor function that returns @widget->style. * * Return value: (transfer none): the widget's #GtkStyle * * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext instead */ GtkStyle* gtk_widget_get_style (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); priv = widget->priv; if (priv->style == NULL) { priv->style = g_object_new (GTK_TYPE_STYLE, "context", gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget), NULL); } return priv->style; } /** * gtk_widget_modify_style: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @style: the #GtkRcStyle holding the style modifications * * Modifies style values on the widget. * * Modifications made using this technique take precedence over * style values set via an RC file, however, they will be overridden * if a style is explicitely set on the widget using gtk_widget_set_style(). * The #GtkRcStyle structure is designed so each field can either be * set or unset, so it is possible, using this function, to modify some * style values and leave the others unchanged. * * Note that modifications made with this function are not cumulative * with previous calls to gtk_widget_modify_style() or with such * functions as gtk_widget_modify_fg(). If you wish to retain * previous values, you must first call gtk_widget_get_modifier_style(), * make your modifications to the returned style, then call * gtk_widget_modify_style() with that style. On the other hand, * if you first call gtk_widget_modify_style(), subsequent calls * to such functions gtk_widget_modify_fg() will have a cumulative * effect with the initial modifications. * * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext with a custom #GtkStyleProvider instead */ void gtk_widget_modify_style (GtkWidget *widget, GtkRcStyle *style) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_RC_STYLE (style)); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_rc_style, gtk_rc_style_copy (style), (GDestroyNotify) g_object_unref); } /** * gtk_widget_get_modifier_style: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the current modifier style for the widget. (As set by * gtk_widget_modify_style().) If no style has previously set, a new * #GtkRcStyle will be created with all values unset, and set as the * modifier style for the widget. If you make changes to this rc * style, you must call gtk_widget_modify_style(), passing in the * returned rc style, to make sure that your changes take effect. * * Caution: passing the style back to gtk_widget_modify_style() will * normally end up destroying it, because gtk_widget_modify_style() copies * the passed-in style and sets the copy as the new modifier style, * thus dropping any reference to the old modifier style. Add a reference * to the modifier style if you want to keep it alive. * * Return value: (transfer none): the modifier style for the widget. * This rc style is owned by the widget. If you want to keep a * pointer to value this around, you must add a refcount using * g_object_ref(). * * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext with a custom #GtkStyleProvider instead */ GtkRcStyle * gtk_widget_get_modifier_style (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkRcStyle *rc_style; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); rc_style = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_rc_style); if (!rc_style) { rc_style = gtk_rc_style_new (); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_rc_style, rc_style, (GDestroyNotify) g_object_unref); } return rc_style; } static void gtk_widget_modify_color_component (GtkWidget *widget, GtkRcFlags component, GtkStateType state, const GdkColor *color) { GtkRcStyle *rc_style = gtk_widget_get_modifier_style (widget); if (color) { switch (component) { case GTK_RC_FG: rc_style->fg[state] = *color; break; case GTK_RC_BG: rc_style->bg[state] = *color; break; case GTK_RC_TEXT: rc_style->text[state] = *color; break; case GTK_RC_BASE: rc_style->base[state] = *color; break; default: g_assert_not_reached(); } rc_style->color_flags[state] |= component; } else rc_style->color_flags[state] &= ~component; gtk_widget_modify_style (widget, rc_style); } static void modifier_style_changed (GtkModifierStyle *style, GtkWidget *widget) { GtkStyleContext *context; context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget); gtk_style_context_invalidate (context); } static GtkModifierStyle * _gtk_widget_get_modifier_properties (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkModifierStyle *style; style = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_modifier_style); if (G_UNLIKELY (!style)) { GtkStyleContext *context; style = _gtk_modifier_style_new (); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_modifier_style, style, (GDestroyNotify) g_object_unref); g_signal_connect (style, "changed", G_CALLBACK (modifier_style_changed), widget); context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget); gtk_style_context_add_provider (context, GTK_STYLE_PROVIDER (style), GTK_STYLE_PROVIDER_PRIORITY_APPLICATION); } return style; } /** * gtk_widget_override_color: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @state: the state for which to set the color * @color: the color to assign, or %NULL to undo the effect * of previous calls to gtk_widget_override_color() * * Sets the color to use for a widget. * * All other style values are left untouched. * * * This API is mostly meant as a quick way for applications to * change a widget appearance. If you are developing a widgets * library and intend this change to be themeable, it is better * done by setting meaningful CSS classes and regions in your * widget/container implementation through gtk_style_context_add_class() * and gtk_style_context_add_region(). * * This way, your widget library can install a #GtkCssProvider * with the %GTK_STYLE_PROVIDER_PRIORITY_FALLBACK priority in order * to provide a default styling for those widgets that need so, and * this theming may fully overridden by the user's theme. * * * Note that for complex widgets this may bring in undesired * results (such as uniform background color everywhere), in * these cases it is better to fully style such widgets through a * #GtkCssProvider with the %GTK_STYLE_PROVIDER_PRIORITY_APPLICATION * priority. * * * Since: 3.0 */ void gtk_widget_override_color (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateFlags state, const GdkRGBA *color) { GtkModifierStyle *style; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); style = _gtk_widget_get_modifier_properties (widget); _gtk_modifier_style_set_color (style, state, color); } /** * gtk_widget_override_background_color: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @state: the state for which to set the background color * @color: the color to assign, or %NULL to undo the effect * of previous calls to gtk_widget_override_background_color() * * Sets the background color to use for a widget. * * All other style values are left untouched. * See gtk_widget_override_color(). * * Since: 3.0 */ void gtk_widget_override_background_color (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateFlags state, const GdkRGBA *color) { GtkModifierStyle *style; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); style = _gtk_widget_get_modifier_properties (widget); _gtk_modifier_style_set_background_color (style, state, color); } /** * gtk_widget_override_font: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @font_desc: the font descriptiong to use, or %NULL to undo * the effect of previous calls to gtk_widget_override_font() * * Sets the font to use for a widget. All other style values are * left untouched. See gtk_widget_override_color(). * * Since: 3.0 */ void gtk_widget_override_font (GtkWidget *widget, const PangoFontDescription *font_desc) { GtkModifierStyle *style; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); style = _gtk_widget_get_modifier_properties (widget); _gtk_modifier_style_set_font (style, font_desc); } /** * gtk_widget_override_symbolic_color: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @name: the name of the symbolic color to modify * @color: (allow-none): the color to assign (does not need * to be allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous * calls to gtk_widget_override_symbolic_color() * * Sets a symbolic color for a widget. * * All other style values are left untouched. * See gtk_widget_override_color() for overriding the foreground * or background color. * * Since: 3.0 */ void gtk_widget_override_symbolic_color (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *name, const GdkRGBA *color) { GtkModifierStyle *style; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); style = _gtk_widget_get_modifier_properties (widget); _gtk_modifier_style_map_color (style, name, color); } /** * gtk_widget_override_cursor: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @cursor: the color to use for primary cursor (does not need to be * allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous calls to * of gtk_widget_override_cursor(). * @secondary_cursor: the color to use for secondary cursor (does not * need to be allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous * calls to of gtk_widget_override_cursor(). * * Sets the cursor color to use in a widget, overriding the * #GtkWidget:cursor-color and #GtkWidget:secondary-cursor-color * style properties. All other style values are left untouched. * See also gtk_widget_modify_style(). * * Note that the underlying properties have the #GdkColor type, * so the alpha value in @primary and @secondary will be ignored. * * Since: 3.0 */ void gtk_widget_override_cursor (GtkWidget *widget, const GdkRGBA *cursor, const GdkRGBA *secondary_cursor) { GtkModifierStyle *style; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); style = _gtk_widget_get_modifier_properties (widget); _gtk_modifier_style_set_color_property (style, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET, "cursor-color", cursor); _gtk_modifier_style_set_color_property (style, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET, "secondary-cursor-color", secondary_cursor); } /** * gtk_widget_modify_fg: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @state: the state for which to set the foreground color * @color: (allow-none): the color to assign (does not need to be allocated), * or %NULL to undo the effect of previous calls to * of gtk_widget_modify_fg(). * * Sets the foreground color for a widget in a particular state. * * All other style values are left untouched. * See also gtk_widget_modify_style(). * * Deprecated:3.0: Use gtk_widget_override_color() instead */ void gtk_widget_modify_fg (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateType state, const GdkColor *color) { GtkStateFlags flags; GdkRGBA rgba; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (state >= GTK_STATE_NORMAL && state <= GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE); switch (state) { case GTK_STATE_ACTIVE: flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE; break; case GTK_STATE_PRELIGHT: flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT; break; case GTK_STATE_SELECTED: flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_SELECTED; break; case GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE: flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE; break; case GTK_STATE_NORMAL: default: flags = 0; } if (color) { rgba.red = color->red / 65535.; rgba.green = color->green / 65535.; rgba.blue = color->blue / 65535.; rgba.alpha = 1; gtk_widget_override_color (widget, flags, &rgba); } else gtk_widget_override_color (widget, flags, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_modify_bg: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @state: the state for which to set the background color * @color: (allow-none): the color to assign (does not need * to be allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous * calls to of gtk_widget_modify_bg(). * * Sets the background color for a widget in a particular state. * * All other style values are left untouched. * See also gtk_widget_modify_style(). * * * Note that "no window" widgets (which have the %GTK_NO_WINDOW * flag set) draw on their parent container's window and thus may * not draw any background themselves. This is the case for e.g. * #GtkLabel. * * To modify the background of such widgets, you have to set the * background color on their parent; if you want to set the background * of a rectangular area around a label, try placing the label in * a #GtkEventBox widget and setting the background color on that. * * * Deprecated:3.0: Use gtk_widget_override_background_color() instead */ void gtk_widget_modify_bg (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateType state, const GdkColor *color) { GtkStateFlags flags; GdkRGBA rgba; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (state >= GTK_STATE_NORMAL && state <= GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE); switch (state) { case GTK_STATE_ACTIVE: flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE; break; case GTK_STATE_PRELIGHT: flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT; break; case GTK_STATE_SELECTED: flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_SELECTED; break; case GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE: flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE; break; case GTK_STATE_NORMAL: default: flags = 0; } if (color) { rgba.red = color->red / 65535.; rgba.green = color->green / 65535.; rgba.blue = color->blue / 65535.; rgba.alpha = 1; gtk_widget_override_background_color (widget, flags, &rgba); } else gtk_widget_override_background_color (widget, flags, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_modify_text: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @state: the state for which to set the text color * @color: (allow-none): the color to assign (does not need to * be allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous * calls to of gtk_widget_modify_text(). * * Sets the text color for a widget in a particular state. * * All other style values are left untouched. * The text color is the foreground color used along with the * base color (see gtk_widget_modify_base()) for widgets such * as #GtkEntry and #GtkTextView. * See also gtk_widget_modify_style(). * * Deprecated:3.0: Use gtk_widget_override_color() instead */ void gtk_widget_modify_text (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateType state, const GdkColor *color) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (state >= GTK_STATE_NORMAL && state <= GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE); gtk_widget_modify_color_component (widget, GTK_RC_TEXT, state, color); } /** * gtk_widget_modify_base: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @state: the state for which to set the base color * @color: (allow-none): the color to assign (does not need to * be allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous * calls to of gtk_widget_modify_base(). * * Sets the base color for a widget in a particular state. * All other style values are left untouched. The base color * is the background color used along with the text color * (see gtk_widget_modify_text()) for widgets such as #GtkEntry * and #GtkTextView. See also gtk_widget_modify_style(). * * * Note that "no window" widgets (which have the %GTK_NO_WINDOW * flag set) draw on their parent container's window and thus may * not draw any background themselves. This is the case for e.g. * #GtkLabel. * * To modify the background of such widgets, you have to set the * base color on their parent; if you want to set the background * of a rectangular area around a label, try placing the label in * a #GtkEventBox widget and setting the base color on that. * * * Deprecated:3.0: Use gtk_widget_override_background_color() instead */ void gtk_widget_modify_base (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateType state, const GdkColor *color) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (state >= GTK_STATE_NORMAL && state <= GTK_STATE_INSENSITIVE); gtk_widget_modify_color_component (widget, GTK_RC_BASE, state, color); } /** * gtk_widget_modify_cursor: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @primary: the color to use for primary cursor (does not need to be * allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous calls to * of gtk_widget_modify_cursor(). * @secondary: the color to use for secondary cursor (does not need to be * allocated), or %NULL to undo the effect of previous calls to * of gtk_widget_modify_cursor(). * * Sets the cursor color to use in a widget, overriding the * #GtkWidget:cursor-color and #GtkWidget:secondary-cursor-color * style properties. * * All other style values are left untouched. * See also gtk_widget_modify_style(). * * Since: 2.12 * * Deprecated: 3.0. Use gtk_widget_override_cursor() instead. */ void gtk_widget_modify_cursor (GtkWidget *widget, const GdkColor *primary, const GdkColor *secondary) { GdkRGBA primary_rgba, secondary_rgba; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); primary_rgba.red = primary->red / 65535.; primary_rgba.green = primary->green / 65535.; primary_rgba.blue = primary->blue / 65535.; primary_rgba.alpha = 1; secondary_rgba.red = secondary->red / 65535.; secondary_rgba.green = secondary->green / 65535.; secondary_rgba.blue = secondary->blue / 65535.; secondary_rgba.alpha = 1; gtk_widget_override_cursor (widget, &primary_rgba, &secondary_rgba); } /** * gtk_widget_modify_font: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @font_desc: (allow-none): the font description to use, or %NULL * to undo the effect of previous calls to gtk_widget_modify_font() * * Sets the font to use for a widget. * * All other style values are left untouched. * See also gtk_widget_modify_style(). * * Deprecated:3.0: Use gtk_widget_override_font() instead */ void gtk_widget_modify_font (GtkWidget *widget, PangoFontDescription *font_desc) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_override_font (widget, font_desc); } static void gtk_widget_real_direction_changed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkTextDirection previous_direction) { gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); } static void gtk_widget_real_style_set (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStyle *previous_style) { } typedef struct { GtkWidget *previous_toplevel; GdkScreen *previous_screen; GdkScreen *new_screen; } HierarchyChangedInfo; static void do_screen_change (GtkWidget *widget, GdkScreen *old_screen, GdkScreen *new_screen) { if (old_screen != new_screen) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (old_screen) { PangoContext *context = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context); if (context) g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context, NULL); } _gtk_tooltip_hide (widget); if (new_screen && priv->context) gtk_style_context_set_screen (priv->context, new_screen); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[SCREEN_CHANGED], 0, old_screen); } } static void gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer client_data) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; HierarchyChangedInfo *info = client_data; gboolean new_anchored = gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget) || (priv->parent && priv->parent->priv->anchored); if (priv->anchored != new_anchored) { g_object_ref (widget); priv->anchored = new_anchored; g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[HIERARCHY_CHANGED], 0, info->previous_toplevel); do_screen_change (widget, info->previous_screen, info->new_screen); if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed_recurse, client_data); g_object_unref (widget); } } /** * _gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @previous_toplevel: Previous toplevel * * Propagates changes in the anchored state to a widget and all * children, unsetting or setting the %ANCHORED flag, and * emitting #GtkWidget::hierarchy-changed. **/ void _gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *previous_toplevel) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; HierarchyChangedInfo info; info.previous_toplevel = previous_toplevel; info.previous_screen = previous_toplevel ? gtk_widget_get_screen (previous_toplevel) : NULL; if (gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget) || (priv->parent && priv->parent->priv->anchored)) info.new_screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (widget); else info.new_screen = NULL; if (info.previous_screen) g_object_ref (info.previous_screen); if (previous_toplevel) g_object_ref (previous_toplevel); gtk_widget_propagate_hierarchy_changed_recurse (widget, &info); if (previous_toplevel) g_object_unref (previous_toplevel); if (info.previous_screen) g_object_unref (info.previous_screen); } static void gtk_widget_propagate_screen_changed_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer client_data) { HierarchyChangedInfo *info = client_data; g_object_ref (widget); do_screen_change (widget, info->previous_screen, info->new_screen); if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), gtk_widget_propagate_screen_changed_recurse, client_data); g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_is_composited: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Whether @widget can rely on having its alpha channel * drawn correctly. On X11 this function returns whether a * compositing manager is running for @widget's screen. * * Please note that the semantics of this call will change * in the future if used on a widget that has a composited * window in its hierarchy (as set by gdk_window_set_composited()). * * Return value: %TRUE if the widget can rely on its alpha * channel being drawn correctly. * * Since: 2.10 */ gboolean gtk_widget_is_composited (GtkWidget *widget) { GdkScreen *screen; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (widget); return gdk_screen_is_composited (screen); } static void propagate_composited_changed (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer dummy) { if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) { gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), propagate_composited_changed, NULL); } g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[COMPOSITED_CHANGED], 0); } void _gtk_widget_propagate_composited_changed (GtkWidget *widget) { propagate_composited_changed (widget, NULL); } /** * _gtk_widget_propagate_screen_changed: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @previous_screen: Previous screen * * Propagates changes in the screen for a widget to all * children, emitting #GtkWidget::screen-changed. **/ void _gtk_widget_propagate_screen_changed (GtkWidget *widget, GdkScreen *previous_screen) { HierarchyChangedInfo info; info.previous_screen = previous_screen; info.new_screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (widget); if (previous_screen) g_object_ref (previous_screen); gtk_widget_propagate_screen_changed_recurse (widget, &info); if (previous_screen) g_object_unref (previous_screen); } static void reset_style_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data) { _gtk_widget_update_path (widget); if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), reset_style_recurse, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_reset_style: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Updates the style context of @widget and all descendents * by updating its widget path. #GtkContainers may want * to use this on a child when reordering it in a way that a different * style might apply to it. See also gtk_container_get_path_for_child(). * * Since: 3.0 */ void gtk_widget_reset_style (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); reset_style_recurse (widget, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_reset_rc_styles: * @widget: a #GtkWidget. * * Reset the styles of @widget and all descendents, so when * they are looked up again, they get the correct values * for the currently loaded RC file settings. * * This function is not useful for applications. * * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext instead, and gtk_widget_reset_style() */ void gtk_widget_reset_rc_styles (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); reset_style_recurse (widget, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_get_default_style: * * Returns the default style used by all widgets initially. * * Returns: (transfer none): the default style. This #GtkStyle * object is owned by GTK+ and should not be modified or freed. * * Deprecated:3.0: Use #GtkStyleContext instead, and * gtk_css_provider_get_default() to obtain a #GtkStyleProvider * with the default widget style information. */ GtkStyle* gtk_widget_get_default_style (void) { if (!gtk_default_style) { gtk_default_style = gtk_style_new (); g_object_ref (gtk_default_style); } return gtk_default_style; } #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG /* Verify invariants, see docs/widget_system.txt for notes on much of * this. Invariants may be temporarily broken while we're in the * process of updating state, of course, so you can only * verify_invariants() after a given operation is complete. * Use push/pop_verify_invariants to help with that. */ static void gtk_widget_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *parent; if (widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count > 0) return; parent = widget->priv->parent; if (widget->priv->mapped) { /* Mapped implies ... */ if (!widget->priv->realized) g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but not realized", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); if (!widget->priv->visible) g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but not visible", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); if (!widget->priv->toplevel) { if (!widget->priv->child_visible) g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but not child_visible", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); } } else { /* Not mapped implies... */ #if 0 /* This check makes sense for normal toplevels, but for * something like a toplevel that is embedded within a clutter * state, mapping may depend on external factors. */ if (widget->priv->toplevel) { if (widget->priv->visible) g_warning ("%s %p toplevel is visible but not mapped", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); } #endif } /* Parent related checks aren't possible if parent has * verifying_invariants_count > 0 because parent needs to recurse * children first before the invariants will hold. */ if (parent == NULL || parent->priv->verifying_invariants_count == 0) { if (parent && parent->priv->realized) { /* Parent realized implies... */ #if 0 /* This is in widget_system.txt but appears to fail * because there's no gtk_container_realize() that * realizes all children... instead we just lazily * wait for map to fix things up. */ if (!widget->priv->realized) g_warning ("%s %p is realized but child %s %p is not realized", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent), parent, G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); #endif } else if (!widget->priv->toplevel) { /* No parent or parent not realized on non-toplevel implies... */ if (widget->priv->realized && !widget->priv->in_reparent) g_warning ("%s %p is not realized but child %s %p is realized", parent ? G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent) : "no parent", parent, G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); } if (parent && parent->priv->mapped && widget->priv->visible && widget->priv->child_visible) { /* Parent mapped and we are visible implies... */ if (!widget->priv->mapped) g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but visible child %s %p is not mapped", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent), parent, G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); } else if (!widget->priv->toplevel) { /* No parent or parent not mapped on non-toplevel implies... */ if (widget->priv->mapped && !widget->priv->in_reparent) g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but visible=%d child_visible=%d parent %s %p mapped=%d", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget, widget->priv->visible, widget->priv->child_visible, parent ? G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent) : "no parent", parent, parent ? parent->priv->mapped : FALSE); } } if (!widget->priv->realized) { /* Not realized implies... */ #if 0 /* widget_system.txt says these hold, but they don't. */ if (widget->priv->resize_pending) g_warning ("%s %p resize pending but not realized", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); if (widget->priv->alloc_needed) g_warning ("%s %p alloc needed but not realized", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); if (widget->priv->width_request_needed) g_warning ("%s %p width request needed but not realized", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); if (widget->priv->height_request_needed) g_warning ("%s %p height request needed but not realized", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); #endif } } /* The point of this push/pop is that invariants may not hold while * we're busy making changes. So we only check at the outermost call * on the call stack, after we finish updating everything. */ static void gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget) { widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count += 1; } static void gtk_widget_verify_child_invariants (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer client_data) { /* We don't recurse further; this is a one-level check. */ gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget); } static void gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget) { g_assert (widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count > 0); widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count -= 1; if (widget->priv->verifying_invariants_count == 0) { gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget); if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) { /* Check one level of children, because our * push_verify_invariants() will have prevented some of the * checks. This does not recurse because if recursion is * needed, it will happen naturally as each child has a * push/pop on that child. For example if we're recursively * mapping children, we'll push/pop on each child as we map * it. */ gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), gtk_widget_verify_child_invariants, NULL); } } } #endif /* G_ENABLE_DEBUG */ static PangoContext * gtk_widget_peek_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget) { return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context); } /** * gtk_widget_get_pango_context: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets a #PangoContext with the appropriate font map, font description, * and base direction for this widget. Unlike the context returned * by gtk_widget_create_pango_context(), this context is owned by * the widget (it can be used until the screen for the widget changes * or the widget is removed from its toplevel), and will be updated to * match any changes to the widget's attributes. * * If you create and keep a #PangoLayout using this context, you must * deal with changes to the context by calling pango_layout_context_changed() * on the layout in response to the #GtkWidget::style-updated and * #GtkWidget::direction-changed signals for the widget. * * Return value: (transfer none): the #PangoContext for the widget. **/ PangoContext * gtk_widget_get_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget) { PangoContext *context; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); context = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context); if (!context) { context = gtk_widget_create_pango_context (GTK_WIDGET (widget)); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context, context, g_object_unref); } return context; } static void update_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget, PangoContext *context) { PangoFontDescription *font_desc; GtkStyleContext *style_context; style_context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget); gtk_style_context_get (style_context, gtk_widget_get_state_flags (widget), "font", &font_desc, NULL); pango_context_set_font_description (context, font_desc); pango_context_set_base_dir (context, gtk_widget_get_direction (widget) == GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR ? PANGO_DIRECTION_LTR : PANGO_DIRECTION_RTL); pango_font_description_free (font_desc); } static void gtk_widget_update_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget) { PangoContext *context = gtk_widget_peek_pango_context (widget); if (context) { GdkScreen *screen; update_pango_context (widget, context); screen = gtk_widget_get_screen_unchecked (widget); if (screen) { pango_cairo_context_set_resolution (context, gdk_screen_get_resolution (screen)); pango_cairo_context_set_font_options (context, gdk_screen_get_font_options (screen)); } } } /** * gtk_widget_create_pango_context: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Creates a new #PangoContext with the appropriate font map, * font description, and base direction for drawing text for * this widget. See also gtk_widget_get_pango_context(). * * Return value: (transfer full): the new #PangoContext **/ PangoContext * gtk_widget_create_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget) { GdkScreen *screen; PangoContext *context; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); screen = gtk_widget_get_screen_unchecked (widget); if (!screen) { GTK_NOTE (MULTIHEAD, g_warning ("gtk_widget_create_pango_context ()) called without screen")); screen = gdk_screen_get_default (); } context = gdk_pango_context_get_for_screen (screen); update_pango_context (widget, context); pango_context_set_language (context, gtk_get_default_language ()); return context; } /** * gtk_widget_create_pango_layout: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @text: text to set on the layout (can be %NULL) * * Creates a new #PangoLayout with the appropriate font map, * font description, and base direction for drawing text for * this widget. * * If you keep a #PangoLayout created in this way around, in order to * notify the layout of changes to the base direction or font of this * widget, you must call pango_layout_context_changed() in response to * the #GtkWidget::style-updated and #GtkWidget::direction-changed signals * for the widget. * * Return value: (transfer full): the new #PangoLayout **/ PangoLayout * gtk_widget_create_pango_layout (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *text) { PangoLayout *layout; PangoContext *context; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); context = gtk_widget_get_pango_context (widget); layout = pango_layout_new (context); if (text) pango_layout_set_text (layout, text, -1); return layout; } /** * gtk_widget_render_icon_pixbuf: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @stock_id: a stock ID * @size: (type int): a stock size. A size of (GtkIconSize)-1 means * render at the size of the source and don't scale (if there are * multiple source sizes, GTK+ picks one of the available sizes). * * A convenience function that uses the theme engine and style * settings for @widget to look up @stock_id and render it to * a pixbuf. @stock_id should be a stock icon ID such as * #GTK_STOCK_OPEN or #GTK_STOCK_OK. @size should be a size * such as #GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU. * * The pixels in the returned #GdkPixbuf are shared with the rest of * the application and should not be modified. The pixbuf should be freed * after use with g_object_unref(). * * Return value: (transfer full): a new pixbuf, or %NULL if the * stock ID wasn't known * * Since: 3.0 **/ GdkPixbuf* gtk_widget_render_icon_pixbuf (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *stock_id, GtkIconSize size) { GtkStyleContext *context; GtkIconSet *icon_set; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); g_return_val_if_fail (stock_id != NULL, NULL); g_return_val_if_fail (size > GTK_ICON_SIZE_INVALID || size == -1, NULL); context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget); icon_set = gtk_style_context_lookup_icon_set (context, stock_id); if (icon_set == NULL) return NULL; return gtk_icon_set_render_icon_pixbuf (icon_set, context, size); } /** * gtk_widget_render_icon: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @stock_id: a stock ID * @size: (type int): a stock size. A size of (GtkIconSize)-1 means * render at the size of the source and don't scale (if there are * multiple source sizes, GTK+ picks one of the available sizes). * @detail: (allow-none): render detail to pass to theme engine * * A convenience function that uses the theme settings for @widget * to look up @stock_id and render it to a pixbuf. @stock_id should * be a stock icon ID such as #GTK_STOCK_OPEN or #GTK_STOCK_OK. @size * should be a size such as #GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU. @detail should be a * string that identifies the widget or code doing the rendering, so * that theme engines can special-case rendering for that widget or * code. * * The pixels in the returned #GdkPixbuf are shared with the rest of * the application and should not be modified. The pixbuf should be * freed after use with g_object_unref(). * * Return value: (transfer full): a new pixbuf, or %NULL if the * stock ID wasn't known * * Deprecated: 3.0: Use gtk_widget_render_icon_pixbuf() instead. **/ GdkPixbuf* gtk_widget_render_icon (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *stock_id, GtkIconSize size, const gchar *detail) { gtk_widget_ensure_style (widget); return gtk_widget_render_icon_pixbuf (widget, stock_id, size); } /** * gtk_widget_set_parent_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget. * @parent_window: the new parent window. * * Sets a non default parent window for @widget. * * For GtkWindow classes, setting a @parent_window effects whether * the window is a toplevel window or can be embedded into other * widgets. * * * For GtkWindow classes, this needs to be called before the * window is realized. * * **/ void gtk_widget_set_parent_window (GtkWidget *widget, GdkWindow *parent_window) { GdkWindow *old_parent_window; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); old_parent_window = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_parent_window); if (parent_window != old_parent_window) { gboolean is_plug; g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_parent_window, parent_window); if (old_parent_window) g_object_unref (old_parent_window); if (parent_window) g_object_ref (parent_window); /* Unset toplevel flag when adding a parent window to a widget, * this is the primary entry point to allow toplevels to be * embeddable. */ #ifdef GDK_WINDOWING_X11 is_plug = GTK_IS_PLUG (widget); #else is_plug = FALSE; #endif if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (widget) && !is_plug) _gtk_window_set_is_toplevel (GTK_WINDOW (widget), parent_window == NULL); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_parent_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget. * * Gets @widget's parent window. * * Returns: (transfer none): the parent window of @widget. **/ GdkWindow * gtk_widget_get_parent_window (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GdkWindow *parent_window; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); priv = widget->priv; parent_window = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_parent_window); return (parent_window != NULL) ? parent_window : (priv->parent != NULL) ? priv->parent->priv->window : NULL; } /** * gtk_widget_set_child_visible: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @is_visible: if %TRUE, @widget should be mapped along with its parent. * * Sets whether @widget should be mapped along with its when its parent * is mapped and @widget has been shown with gtk_widget_show(). * * The child visibility can be set for widget before it is added to * a container with gtk_widget_set_parent(), to avoid mapping * children unnecessary before immediately unmapping them. However * it will be reset to its default state of %TRUE when the widget * is removed from a container. * * Note that changing the child visibility of a widget does not * queue a resize on the widget. Most of the time, the size of * a widget is computed from all visible children, whether or * not they are mapped. If this is not the case, the container * can queue a resize itself. * * This function is only useful for container implementations and * never should be called by an application. **/ void gtk_widget_set_child_visible (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean is_visible) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (!gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)); priv = widget->priv; g_object_ref (widget); gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget); if (is_visible) priv->child_visible = TRUE; else { GtkWidget *toplevel; priv->child_visible = FALSE; toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (toplevel != widget && gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel)) _gtk_window_unset_focus_and_default (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget); } if (priv->parent && gtk_widget_get_realized (priv->parent)) { if (gtk_widget_get_mapped (priv->parent) && priv->child_visible && gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) gtk_widget_map (widget); else gtk_widget_unmap (widget); } gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget); g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_get_child_visible: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the value set with gtk_widget_set_child_visible(). * If you feel a need to use this function, your code probably * needs reorganization. * * This function is only useful for container implementations and * never should be called by an application. * * Return value: %TRUE if the widget is mapped with the parent. **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_child_visible (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->child_visible; } static GdkScreen * gtk_widget_get_screen_unchecked (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *toplevel; toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel)) { if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) return gtk_window_get_screen (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel)); else if (GTK_IS_INVISIBLE (toplevel)) return gtk_invisible_get_screen (GTK_INVISIBLE (widget)); } return NULL; } /** * gtk_widget_get_screen: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Get the #GdkScreen from the toplevel window associated with * this widget. This function can only be called after the widget * has been added to a widget hierarchy with a #GtkWindow * at the top. * * In general, you should only create screen specific * resources when a widget has been realized, and you should * free those resources when the widget is unrealized. * * Return value: (transfer none): the #GdkScreen for the toplevel for this widget. * * Since: 2.2 **/ GdkScreen* gtk_widget_get_screen (GtkWidget *widget) { GdkScreen *screen; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); screen = gtk_widget_get_screen_unchecked (widget); if (screen) return screen; else { #if 0 g_warning (G_STRLOC ": Can't get associated screen" " for a widget unless it is inside a toplevel GtkWindow\n" " widget type is %s associated top level type is %s", g_type_name (G_OBJECT_TYPE(G_OBJECT (widget))), g_type_name (G_OBJECT_TYPE(G_OBJECT (toplevel)))); #endif return gdk_screen_get_default (); } } /** * gtk_widget_has_screen: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Checks whether there is a #GdkScreen is associated with * this widget. All toplevel widgets have an associated * screen, and all widgets added into a hierarchy with a toplevel * window at the top. * * Return value: %TRUE if there is a #GdkScreen associcated * with the widget. * * Since: 2.2 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_has_screen (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return (gtk_widget_get_screen_unchecked (widget) != NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_get_display: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Get the #GdkDisplay for the toplevel window associated with * this widget. This function can only be called after the widget * has been added to a widget hierarchy with a #GtkWindow at the top. * * In general, you should only create display specific * resources when a widget has been realized, and you should * free those resources when the widget is unrealized. * * Return value: (transfer none): the #GdkDisplay for the toplevel for this widget. * * Since: 2.2 **/ GdkDisplay* gtk_widget_get_display (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return gdk_screen_get_display (gtk_widget_get_screen (widget)); } /** * gtk_widget_get_root_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Get the root window where this widget is located. This function can * only be called after the widget has been added to a widget * hierarchy with #GtkWindow at the top. * * The root window is useful for such purposes as creating a popup * #GdkWindow associated with the window. In general, you should only * create display specific resources when a widget has been realized, * and you should free those resources when the widget is unrealized. * * Return value: (transfer none): the #GdkWindow root window for the toplevel for this widget. * * Since: 2.2 **/ GdkWindow* gtk_widget_get_root_window (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return gdk_screen_get_root_window (gtk_widget_get_screen (widget)); } /** * gtk_widget_child_focus: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @direction: direction of focus movement * * This function is used by custom widget implementations; if you're * writing an app, you'd use gtk_widget_grab_focus() to move the focus * to a particular widget, and gtk_container_set_focus_chain() to * change the focus tab order. So you may want to investigate those * functions instead. * * gtk_widget_child_focus() is called by containers as the user moves * around the window using keyboard shortcuts. @direction indicates * what kind of motion is taking place (up, down, left, right, tab * forward, tab backward). gtk_widget_child_focus() emits the * #GtkWidget::focus signal; widgets override the default handler * for this signal in order to implement appropriate focus behavior. * * The default ::focus handler for a widget should return %TRUE if * moving in @direction left the focus on a focusable location inside * that widget, and %FALSE if moving in @direction moved the focus * outside the widget. If returning %TRUE, widgets normally * call gtk_widget_grab_focus() to place the focus accordingly; * if returning %FALSE, they don't modify the current focus location. * * Return value: %TRUE if focus ended up inside @widget **/ gboolean gtk_widget_child_focus (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction) { gboolean return_val; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); if (!gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) || !gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) return FALSE; /* child widgets must set CAN_FOCUS, containers * don't have to though. */ if (!GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget) && !gtk_widget_get_can_focus (widget)) return FALSE; g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[FOCUS], 0, direction, &return_val); return return_val; } /** * gtk_widget_keynav_failed: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @direction: direction of focus movement * * This function should be called whenever keyboard navigation within * a single widget hits a boundary. The function emits the * #GtkWidget::keynav-failed signal on the widget and its return * value should be interpreted in a way similar to the return value of * gtk_widget_child_focus(): * * When %TRUE is returned, stay in the widget, the failed keyboard * navigation is Ok and/or there is nowhere we can/should move the * focus to. * * When %FALSE is returned, the caller should continue with keyboard * navigation outside the widget, e.g. by calling * gtk_widget_child_focus() on the widget's toplevel. * * The default ::keynav-failed handler returns %TRUE for * %GTK_DIR_TAB_FORWARD and %GTK_DIR_TAB_BACKWARD. For the other * values of #GtkDirectionType, it looks at the * #GtkSettings:gtk-keynav-cursor-only setting and returns %FALSE * if the setting is %TRUE. This way the entire user interface * becomes cursor-navigatable on input devices such as mobile phones * which only have cursor keys but no tab key. * * Whenever the default handler returns %TRUE, it also calls * gtk_widget_error_bell() to notify the user of the failed keyboard * navigation. * * A use case for providing an own implementation of ::keynav-failed * (either by connecting to it or by overriding it) would be a row of * #GtkEntry widgets where the user should be able to navigate the * entire row with the cursor keys, as e.g. known from user interfaces * that require entering license keys. * * Return value: %TRUE if stopping keyboard navigation is fine, %FALSE * if the emitting widget should try to handle the keyboard * navigation attempt in its parent container(s). * * Since: 2.12 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_keynav_failed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkDirectionType direction) { gboolean return_val; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[KEYNAV_FAILED], 0, direction, &return_val); return return_val; } /** * gtk_widget_error_bell: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Notifies the user about an input-related error on this widget. * If the #GtkSettings:gtk-error-bell setting is %TRUE, it calls * gdk_window_beep(), otherwise it does nothing. * * Note that the effect of gdk_window_beep() can be configured in many * ways, depending on the windowing backend and the desktop environment * or window manager that is used. * * Since: 2.12 **/ void gtk_widget_error_bell (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GtkSettings* settings; gboolean beep; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; settings = gtk_widget_get_settings (widget); if (!settings) return; g_object_get (settings, "gtk-error-bell", &beep, NULL); if (beep && priv->window) gdk_window_beep (priv->window); } static void gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (GtkWidget *widget, gint width, gint height, GtkQueueResizeFlags flags) { GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info; gboolean changed = FALSE; g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, TRUE); if (width > -2 && aux_info->width != width) { if ((flags & GTK_QUEUE_RESIZE_INVALIDATE_ONLY) == 0) g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "width-request"); aux_info->width = width; changed = TRUE; } if (height > -2 && aux_info->height != height) { if ((flags & GTK_QUEUE_RESIZE_INVALIDATE_ONLY) == 0) g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "height-request"); aux_info->height = height; changed = TRUE; } if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) && changed) { if ((flags & GTK_QUEUE_RESIZE_INVALIDATE_ONLY) == 0) gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); else _gtk_size_group_queue_resize (widget, GTK_QUEUE_RESIZE_INVALIDATE_ONLY); } g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); } /** * gtk_widget_set_size_request: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @width: width @widget should request, or -1 to unset * @height: height @widget should request, or -1 to unset * * Sets the minimum size of a widget; that is, the widget's size * request will be @width by @height. You can use this function to * force a widget to be either larger or smaller than it normally * would be. * * In most cases, gtk_window_set_default_size() is a better choice for * toplevel windows than this function; setting the default size will * still allow users to shrink the window. Setting the size request * will force them to leave the window at least as large as the size * request. When dealing with window sizes, * gtk_window_set_geometry_hints() can be a useful function as well. * * Note the inherent danger of setting any fixed size - themes, * translations into other languages, different fonts, and user action * can all change the appropriate size for a given widget. So, it's * basically impossible to hardcode a size that will always be * correct. * * The size request of a widget is the smallest size a widget can * accept while still functioning well and drawing itself correctly. * However in some strange cases a widget may be allocated less than * its requested size, and in many cases a widget may be allocated more * space than it requested. * * If the size request in a given direction is -1 (unset), then * the "natural" size request of the widget will be used instead. * * Widgets can't actually be allocated a size less than 1 by 1, but * you can pass 0,0 to this function to mean "as small as possible." * * The size request set here does not include any margin from the * #GtkWidget properties margin-left, margin-right, margin-top, and * margin-bottom, but it does include pretty much all other padding * or border properties set by any subclass of #GtkWidget. **/ void gtk_widget_set_size_request (GtkWidget *widget, gint width, gint height) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (width >= -1); g_return_if_fail (height >= -1); if (width == 0) width = 1; if (height == 0) height = 1; gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, width, height, 0); } /** * gtk_widget_get_size_request: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @width: (out) (allow-none): return location for width, or %NULL * @height: (out) (allow-none): return location for height, or %NULL * * Gets the size request that was explicitly set for the widget using * gtk_widget_set_size_request(). A value of -1 stored in @width or * @height indicates that that dimension has not been set explicitly * and the natural requisition of the widget will be used intead. See * gtk_widget_set_size_request(). To get the size a widget will * actually request, call gtk_widget_get_preferred_size() instead of * this function. **/ void gtk_widget_get_size_request (GtkWidget *widget, gint *width, gint *height) { const GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); aux_info = _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget); if (width) *width = aux_info->width; if (height) *height = aux_info->height; } /** * _gtk_widget_override_size_request: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @width: new forced minimum width * @height: new forced minimum height * @old_width: location to store previous forced minimum width * @old_width: location to store previous forced minumum height * * Temporarily establishes a forced minimum size for a widget; this * is used by GtkWindow when calculating the size to add to the * window's geometry widget. Cached sizes for the widget and its * parents are invalidated, so that subsequent calls to the size * negotiation machinery produce the overriden result, but the * widget is not queued for relayout or redraw. The old size must * be restored with _gtk_widget_restore_size_request() or things * will go screwy. */ void _gtk_widget_override_size_request (GtkWidget *widget, int width, int height, int *old_width, int *old_height) { gtk_widget_get_size_request (widget, old_width, old_height); gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, width, height, GTK_QUEUE_RESIZE_INVALIDATE_ONLY); } /** * _gtk_widget_restore_size_request: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @old_width: saved forced minimum size * @old_height: saved forced minimum size * * Undoes the operation of_gtk_widget_override_size_request(). */ void _gtk_widget_restore_size_request (GtkWidget *widget, int old_width, int old_height) { gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, old_width, old_height, GTK_QUEUE_RESIZE_INVALIDATE_ONLY); } /** * gtk_widget_set_events: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @events: event mask * * Sets the event mask (see #GdkEventMask) for a widget. The event * mask determines which events a widget will receive. Keep in mind * that different widgets have different default event masks, and by * changing the event mask you may disrupt a widget's functionality, * so be careful. This function must be called while a widget is * unrealized. Consider gtk_widget_add_events() for widgets that are * already realized, or if you want to preserve the existing event * mask. This function can't be used with #GTK_NO_WINDOW widgets; * to get events on those widgets, place them inside a #GtkEventBox * and receive events on the event box. **/ void gtk_widget_set_events (GtkWidget *widget, gint events) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)); g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_event_mask, GINT_TO_POINTER (events)); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "events"); } /** * gtk_widget_set_device_events: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @device: a #GdkDevice * @events: event mask * * Sets the device event mask (see #GdkEventMask) for a widget. The event * mask determines which events a widget will receive from @device. Keep * in mind that different widgets have different default event masks, and by * changing the event mask you may disrupt a widget's functionality, * so be careful. This function must be called while a widget is * unrealized. Consider gtk_widget_add_device_events() for widgets that are * already realized, or if you want to preserve the existing event * mask. This function can't be used with #GTK_NO_WINDOW widgets; * to get events on those widgets, place them inside a #GtkEventBox * and receive events on the event box. * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_set_device_events (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device, GdkEventMask events) { GHashTable *device_events; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device)); g_return_if_fail (!gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)); device_events = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_device_event_mask); if (G_UNLIKELY (!device_events)) { device_events = g_hash_table_new (NULL, NULL); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_device_event_mask, device_events, (GDestroyNotify) g_hash_table_unref); } g_hash_table_insert (device_events, device, GUINT_TO_POINTER (events)); } /** * gtk_widget_set_device_enabled: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @device: a #GdkDevice * @enabled: whether to enable the device * * Enables or disables a #GdkDevice to interact with @widget * and all its children. * * It does so by descending through the #GdkWindow hierarchy * and enabling the same mask that is has for core events * (i.e. the one that gdk_window_get_events() returns). * * Since: 3.0 */ void gtk_widget_set_device_enabled (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device, gboolean enabled) { GList *enabled_devices; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device)); enabled_devices = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_enabled_devices); enabled_devices = g_list_append (enabled_devices, device); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_enabled_devices, enabled_devices, (GDestroyNotify) g_list_free);; if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) gtk_widget_set_device_enabled_internal (widget, device, TRUE, enabled); } /** * gtk_widget_get_device_enabled: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @device: a #GdkDevice * * Returns whether @device can interact with @widget and its * children. See gtk_widget_set_device_enabled(). * * Return value: %TRUE is @device is enabled for @widget * * Since: 3.0 */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_device_enabled (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device) { GList *enabled_devices; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_return_val_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device), FALSE); enabled_devices = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_enabled_devices); return g_list_find (enabled_devices, device) != NULL; } static void gtk_widget_add_events_internal_list (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device, gint events, GList *window_list) { GList *l; for (l = window_list; l != NULL; l = l->next) { GdkWindow *window = l->data; gpointer user_data; gdk_window_get_user_data (window, &user_data); if (user_data == widget) { GList *children; if (device) gdk_window_set_device_events (window, device, gdk_window_get_events (window) | events); else gdk_window_set_events (window, gdk_window_get_events (window) | events); children = gdk_window_get_children (window); gtk_widget_add_events_internal_list (widget, device, events, children); g_list_free (children); } } } static void gtk_widget_add_events_internal (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device, gint events) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; GList *window_list; if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) window_list = gdk_window_get_children (priv->window); else window_list = g_list_prepend (NULL, priv->window); gtk_widget_add_events_internal_list (widget, device, events, window_list); g_list_free (window_list); } /** * gtk_widget_add_events: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @events: an event mask, see #GdkEventMask * * Adds the events in the bitfield @events to the event mask for * @widget. See gtk_widget_set_events() for details. **/ void gtk_widget_add_events (GtkWidget *widget, gint events) { gint old_events; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); old_events = GPOINTER_TO_INT (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_event_mask)); g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_event_mask, GINT_TO_POINTER (old_events | events)); if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) { gtk_widget_add_events_internal (widget, NULL, events); gtk_widget_update_devices_mask (widget, FALSE); } g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "events"); } /** * gtk_widget_add_device_events: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @device: a #GdkDevice * @events: an event mask, see #GdkEventMask * * Adds the device events in the bitfield @events to the event mask for * @widget. See gtk_widget_set_device_events() for details. * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_add_device_events (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device, GdkEventMask events) { GdkEventMask old_events; GHashTable *device_events; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device)); old_events = gtk_widget_get_device_events (widget, device); device_events = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_device_event_mask); if (G_UNLIKELY (!device_events)) { device_events = g_hash_table_new (NULL, NULL); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_device_event_mask, device_events, (GDestroyNotify) g_hash_table_unref); } g_hash_table_insert (device_events, device, GUINT_TO_POINTER (old_events | events)); if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) gtk_widget_add_events_internal (widget, device, events); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "events"); } /** * gtk_widget_get_toplevel: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * This function returns the topmost widget in the container hierarchy * @widget is a part of. If @widget has no parent widgets, it will be * returned as the topmost widget. No reference will be added to the * returned widget; it should not be unreferenced. * * Note the difference in behavior vs. gtk_widget_get_ancestor(); * gtk_widget_get_ancestor (widget, GTK_TYPE_WINDOW) * would return * %NULL if @widget wasn't inside a toplevel window, and if the * window was inside a #GtkWindow-derived widget which was in turn * inside the toplevel #GtkWindow. While the second case may * seem unlikely, it actually happens when a #GtkPlug is embedded * inside a #GtkSocket within the same application. * * To reliably find the toplevel #GtkWindow, use * gtk_widget_get_toplevel() and check if the %TOPLEVEL flags * is set on the result. * |[ * GtkWidget *toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); * if (gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel)) * { * /* Perform action on toplevel. */ * } * ]| * * Return value: (transfer none): the topmost ancestor of @widget, or @widget itself * if there's no ancestor. **/ GtkWidget* gtk_widget_get_toplevel (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); while (widget->priv->parent) widget = widget->priv->parent; return widget; } /** * gtk_widget_get_ancestor: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @widget_type: ancestor type * * Gets the first ancestor of @widget with type @widget_type. For example, * gtk_widget_get_ancestor (widget, GTK_TYPE_BOX) gets * the first #GtkBox that's an ancestor of @widget. No reference will be * added to the returned widget; it should not be unreferenced. See note * about checking for a toplevel #GtkWindow in the docs for * gtk_widget_get_toplevel(). * * Note that unlike gtk_widget_is_ancestor(), gtk_widget_get_ancestor() * considers @widget to be an ancestor of itself. * * Return value: (transfer none): the ancestor widget, or %NULL if not found **/ GtkWidget* gtk_widget_get_ancestor (GtkWidget *widget, GType widget_type) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); while (widget && !g_type_is_a (G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget), widget_type)) widget = widget->priv->parent; if (!(widget && g_type_is_a (G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget), widget_type))) return NULL; return widget; } /** * gtk_widget_set_visual: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @visual: visual to be used or %NULL to unset a previous one * * Sets the visual that should be used for by widget and its children for * creating #GdkWindows. The visual must be on the same #GdkScreen as * returned by gdk_widget_get_screen(), so handling the * #GtkWidget::screen-changed signal is necessary. * * Setting a new @visual will not cause @widget to recreate its windows, * so you should call this function before @widget is realized. **/ void gtk_widget_set_visual (GtkWidget *widget, GdkVisual *visual) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (visual == NULL || GDK_IS_VISUAL (visual)); if (visual) { g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_screen (widget) == gdk_visual_get_screen (visual)); } g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_visual, g_object_ref (visual), g_object_unref); } /** * gtk_widget_get_visual: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the visual that will be used to render @widget. * * Return value: (transfer none): the visual for @widget **/ GdkVisual* gtk_widget_get_visual (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *w; GdkVisual *visual; GdkScreen *screen; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget) && widget->priv->window) return gdk_window_get_visual (widget->priv->window); screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (widget); for (w = widget; w != NULL; w = w->priv->parent) { visual = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (w), quark_visual); if (visual) { if (gdk_visual_get_screen (visual) == screen) return visual; g_warning ("Ignoring visual set on widget `%s' that is not on the correct screen.", gtk_widget_get_name (widget)); } } return gdk_screen_get_system_visual (screen); } /** * gtk_widget_get_settings: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the settings object holding the settings used for this widget. * * Note that this function can only be called when the #GtkWidget * is attached to a toplevel, since the settings object is specific * to a particular #GdkScreen. * * Return value: (transfer none): the relevant #GtkSettings object */ GtkSettings* gtk_widget_get_settings (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return gtk_settings_get_for_screen (gtk_widget_get_screen (widget)); } /** * gtk_widget_get_events: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the event mask for the widget (a bitfield containing flags * from the #GdkEventMask enumeration). These are the events that the widget * will receive. * * Return value: event mask for @widget **/ gint gtk_widget_get_events (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return GPOINTER_TO_INT (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_event_mask)); } /** * gtk_widget_get_device_events: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @device: a #GdkDevice * * Returns the events mask for the widget corresponding to an specific device. These * are the events that the widget will receive when @device operates on it. * * Returns: device event mask for @widget * * Since: 3.0 **/ GdkEventMask gtk_widget_get_device_events (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device) { GHashTable *device_events; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); g_return_val_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device), 0); device_events = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_device_event_mask); if (!device_events) return 0; return GPOINTER_TO_UINT (g_hash_table_lookup (device_events, device)); } /** * gtk_widget_get_pointer: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @x: (out) (allow-none): return location for the X coordinate, or %NULL * @y: (out) (allow-none): return location for the Y coordinate, or %NULL * * Obtains the location of the mouse pointer in widget coordinates. * Widget coordinates are a bit odd; for historical reasons, they are * defined as @widget->window coordinates for widgets that are not * #GTK_NO_WINDOW widgets, and are relative to @widget->allocation.x, * @widget->allocation.y for widgets that are #GTK_NO_WINDOW widgets. **/ void gtk_widget_get_pointer (GtkWidget *widget, gint *x, gint *y) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; if (x) *x = -1; if (y) *y = -1; if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) { gdk_window_get_pointer (priv->window, x, y, NULL); if (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) { if (x) *x -= priv->allocation.x; if (y) *y -= priv->allocation.y; } } } /** * gtk_widget_is_ancestor: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @ancestor: another #GtkWidget * * Determines whether @widget is somewhere inside @ancestor, possibly with * intermediate containers. * * Return value: %TRUE if @ancestor contains @widget as a child, * grandchild, great grandchild, etc. **/ gboolean gtk_widget_is_ancestor (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *ancestor) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_return_val_if_fail (ancestor != NULL, FALSE); while (widget) { if (widget->priv->parent == ancestor) return TRUE; widget = widget->priv->parent; } return FALSE; } static GQuark quark_composite_name = 0; /** * gtk_widget_set_composite_name: * @widget: a #GtkWidget. * @name: the name to set * * Sets a widgets composite name. The widget must be * a composite child of its parent; see gtk_widget_push_composite_child(). **/ void gtk_widget_set_composite_name (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *name) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (widget->priv->composite_child); g_return_if_fail (name != NULL); if (!quark_composite_name) quark_composite_name = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-composite-name"); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_composite_name, g_strdup (name), g_free); } /** * gtk_widget_get_composite_name: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Obtains the composite name of a widget. * * Returns: the composite name of @widget, or %NULL if @widget is not * a composite child. The string should be freed when it is no * longer needed. **/ gchar* gtk_widget_get_composite_name (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); priv = widget->priv; if (widget->priv->composite_child && priv->parent) return _gtk_container_child_composite_name (GTK_CONTAINER (priv->parent), widget); else return NULL; } /** * gtk_widget_push_composite_child: * * Makes all newly-created widgets as composite children until * the corresponding gtk_widget_pop_composite_child() call. * * A composite child is a child that's an implementation detail of the * container it's inside and should not be visible to people using the * container. Composite children aren't treated differently by GTK (but * see gtk_container_foreach() vs. gtk_container_forall()), but e.g. GUI * builders might want to treat them in a different way. * * Here is a simple example: * |[ * gtk_widget_push_composite_child (); * scrolled_window->hscrollbar = gtk_scrollbar_new (GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, hadjustment); * gtk_widget_set_composite_name (scrolled_window->hscrollbar, "hscrollbar"); * gtk_widget_pop_composite_child (); * gtk_widget_set_parent (scrolled_window->hscrollbar, * GTK_WIDGET (scrolled_window)); * g_object_ref (scrolled_window->hscrollbar); * ]| **/ void gtk_widget_push_composite_child (void) { composite_child_stack++; } /** * gtk_widget_pop_composite_child: * * Cancels the effect of a previous call to gtk_widget_push_composite_child(). **/ void gtk_widget_pop_composite_child (void) { if (composite_child_stack) composite_child_stack--; } static void gtk_widget_emit_direction_changed (GtkWidget *widget, GtkTextDirection old_dir) { gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget); if (widget->priv->context) gtk_style_context_set_direction (widget->priv->context, gtk_widget_get_direction (widget)); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[DIRECTION_CHANGED], 0, old_dir); } /** * gtk_widget_set_direction: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @dir: the new direction * * Sets the reading direction on a particular widget. This direction * controls the primary direction for widgets containing text, * and also the direction in which the children of a container are * packed. The ability to set the direction is present in order * so that correct localization into languages with right-to-left * reading directions can be done. Generally, applications will * let the default reading direction present, except for containers * where the containers are arranged in an order that is explicitely * visual rather than logical (such as buttons for text justification). * * If the direction is set to %GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE, then the value * set by gtk_widget_set_default_direction() will be used. **/ void gtk_widget_set_direction (GtkWidget *widget, GtkTextDirection dir) { GtkTextDirection old_dir; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (dir >= GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE && dir <= GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL); old_dir = gtk_widget_get_direction (widget); widget->priv->direction = dir; if (old_dir != gtk_widget_get_direction (widget)) gtk_widget_emit_direction_changed (widget, old_dir); } /** * gtk_widget_get_direction: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the reading direction for a particular widget. See * gtk_widget_set_direction(). * * Return value: the reading direction for the widget. **/ GtkTextDirection gtk_widget_get_direction (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR); if (widget->priv->direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE) return gtk_default_direction; else return widget->priv->direction; } static void gtk_widget_set_default_direction_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data) { GtkTextDirection old_dir = GPOINTER_TO_UINT (data); g_object_ref (widget); if (widget->priv->direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE) gtk_widget_emit_direction_changed (widget, old_dir); if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), gtk_widget_set_default_direction_recurse, data); g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_set_default_direction: * @dir: the new default direction. This cannot be * %GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE. * * Sets the default reading direction for widgets where the * direction has not been explicitly set by gtk_widget_set_direction(). **/ void gtk_widget_set_default_direction (GtkTextDirection dir) { g_return_if_fail (dir == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL || dir == GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR); if (dir != gtk_default_direction) { GList *toplevels, *tmp_list; GtkTextDirection old_dir = gtk_default_direction; gtk_default_direction = dir; tmp_list = toplevels = gtk_window_list_toplevels (); g_list_foreach (toplevels, (GFunc)g_object_ref, NULL); while (tmp_list) { gtk_widget_set_default_direction_recurse (tmp_list->data, GUINT_TO_POINTER (old_dir)); g_object_unref (tmp_list->data); tmp_list = tmp_list->next; } g_list_free (toplevels); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_default_direction: * * Obtains the current default reading direction. See * gtk_widget_set_default_direction(). * * Return value: the current default direction. **/ GtkTextDirection gtk_widget_get_default_direction (void) { return gtk_default_direction; } static void gtk_widget_dispose (GObject *object) { GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (priv->parent) gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (priv->parent), widget); else if (gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) gtk_widget_hide (widget); priv->visible = FALSE; if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) gtk_widget_unrealize (widget); if (!priv->in_destruction) { priv->in_destruction = TRUE; g_signal_emit (object, widget_signals[DESTROY], 0); priv->in_destruction = FALSE; } G_OBJECT_CLASS (gtk_widget_parent_class)->dispose (object); } static void gtk_widget_real_destroy (GtkWidget *object) { /* gtk_object_destroy() will already hold a refcount on object */ GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; /* wipe accelerator closures (keep order) */ g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_path, NULL); g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures, NULL); /* Callers of add_mnemonic_label() should disconnect on ::destroy */ g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels, NULL); gtk_grab_remove (widget); if (priv->style) g_object_unref (priv->style); priv->style = gtk_widget_get_default_style (); g_object_ref (priv->style); } static void gtk_widget_finalize (GObject *object) { GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info; GtkAccessible *accessible; gtk_grab_remove (widget); g_object_unref (priv->style); priv->style = NULL; g_free (priv->name); aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, FALSE); if (aux_info) gtk_widget_aux_info_destroy (aux_info); accessible = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accessible_object); if (accessible) g_object_unref (accessible); if (priv->path) gtk_widget_path_free (priv->path); if (priv->context) g_object_unref (priv->context); _gtk_widget_free_cached_sizes (widget); if (g_object_is_floating (object)) g_warning ("A floating object was finalized. This means that someone\n" "called g_object_unref() on an object that had only a floating\n" "reference; the initial floating reference is not owned by anyone\n" "and must be removed with g_object_ref_sink()."); G_OBJECT_CLASS (gtk_widget_parent_class)->finalize (object); } /***************************************** * gtk_widget_real_map: * * arguments: * * results: *****************************************/ static void gtk_widget_real_map (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; g_assert (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)); if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) { gtk_widget_set_mapped (widget, TRUE); if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) gdk_window_show (priv->window); } } /***************************************** * gtk_widget_real_unmap: * * arguments: * * results: *****************************************/ static void gtk_widget_real_unmap (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; if (gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) { gtk_widget_set_mapped (widget, FALSE); if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) gdk_window_hide (priv->window); } } /***************************************** * gtk_widget_real_realize: * * arguments: * * results: *****************************************/ static void gtk_widget_real_realize (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; g_assert (!gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)); gtk_widget_set_realized (widget, TRUE); if (priv->parent) { priv->window = gtk_widget_get_parent_window (widget); g_object_ref (priv->window); } } /***************************************** * gtk_widget_real_unrealize: * * arguments: * * results: *****************************************/ static void gtk_widget_real_unrealize (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; g_assert (!widget->priv->mapped); /* printf ("unrealizing %s\n", g_type_name (G_TYPE_FROM_INSTANCE (widget))); */ /* We must do unrealize child widget BEFORE container widget. * gdk_window_destroy() destroys specified xwindow and its sub-xwindows. * So, unrealizing container widget bofore its children causes the problem * (for example, gdk_ic_destroy () with destroyed window causes crash. ) */ if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), (GtkCallback) gtk_widget_unrealize, NULL); if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) { gdk_window_set_user_data (priv->window, NULL); gdk_window_destroy (priv->window); priv->window = NULL; } else { g_object_unref (priv->window); priv->window = NULL; } gtk_selection_remove_all (widget); gtk_widget_set_realized (widget, FALSE); } static void gtk_widget_real_adjust_size_request (GtkWidget *widget, GtkOrientation orientation, gint *minimum_size, gint *natural_size) { const GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info; aux_info =_gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget); if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL && aux_info->width > 0) { *minimum_size = MAX (*minimum_size, aux_info->width); } else if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL && aux_info->height > 0) { *minimum_size = MAX (*minimum_size, aux_info->height); } /* Fix it if set_size_request made natural size smaller than min size. * This would also silently fix broken widgets, but we warn about them * in gtksizerequest.c when calling their size request vfuncs. */ *natural_size = MAX (*natural_size, *minimum_size); if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) { *minimum_size += (aux_info->margin.left + aux_info->margin.right); *natural_size += (aux_info->margin.left + aux_info->margin.right); } else { *minimum_size += (aux_info->margin.top + aux_info->margin.bottom); *natural_size += (aux_info->margin.top + aux_info->margin.bottom); } } /** * _gtk_widget_peek_request_cache: * * Returns the address of the widget's request cache (strictly for * internal use in gtksizerequest.c) * * Return value: the address of @widget's size request cache. **/ gpointer _gtk_widget_peek_request_cache (GtkWidget *widget) { /* Don't bother slowing things down with the return_if_fail guards here */ return &widget->priv->requests; } /* * _gtk_widget_set_device_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @device: a #GdkDevice * @window: the new device window * * Sets pointer window for @widget and @device. * Does not ref @window. */ void _gtk_widget_set_device_window (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device, GdkWindow *window) { GHashTable *device_window; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device)); g_return_if_fail (window == NULL || GDK_IS_WINDOW (window)); if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) return; device_window = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pointer_window); if (!device_window && window) { device_window = g_hash_table_new (NULL, NULL); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pointer_window, device_window, (GDestroyNotify) g_hash_table_destroy); } if (window) g_hash_table_insert (device_window, device, window); else if (device_window) { g_hash_table_remove (device_window, device); if (g_hash_table_size (device_window) == 0) g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pointer_window, NULL); } } /* * _gtk_widget_get_device_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @device: a #GdkDevice * * Return value: the device window set on @widget, or %NULL */ GdkWindow * _gtk_widget_get_device_window (GtkWidget *widget, GdkDevice *device) { GHashTable *device_window; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); g_return_val_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device), NULL); if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) return NULL; device_window = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pointer_window); if (!device_window) return NULL; return g_hash_table_lookup (device_window, device); } /* * _gtk_widget_list_devices: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the list of #GdkDevices that is currently on top * of any window belonging to @widget. * Free the list with g_list_free(), the elements are owned * by GTK+ and must not be freed. */ GList * _gtk_widget_list_devices (GtkWidget *widget) { GHashTableIter iter; GHashTable *device_window; GList *devices = NULL; gpointer key, value; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); if (!gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) return NULL; device_window = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pointer_window); if (G_UNLIKELY (!device_window)) return NULL; g_hash_table_iter_init (&iter, device_window); while (g_hash_table_iter_next (&iter, &key, &value)) devices = g_list_prepend (devices, key); return devices; } static void synth_crossing (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEventType type, GdkWindow *window, GdkDevice *device, GdkCrossingMode mode, GdkNotifyType detail) { GdkEvent *event; event = gdk_event_new (type); event->crossing.window = g_object_ref (window); event->crossing.send_event = TRUE; event->crossing.subwindow = g_object_ref (window); event->crossing.time = GDK_CURRENT_TIME; event->crossing.x = event->crossing.y = 0; event->crossing.x_root = event->crossing.y_root = 0; event->crossing.mode = mode; event->crossing.detail = detail; event->crossing.focus = FALSE; event->crossing.state = 0; gdk_event_set_device (event, device); if (!widget) widget = gtk_get_event_widget (event); if (widget) gtk_widget_event_internal (widget, event); gdk_event_free (event); } /* * _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing: * @from: the #GtkWidget the virtual pointer is leaving. * @to: the #GtkWidget the virtual pointer is moving to. * @mode: the #GdkCrossingMode to place on the synthesized events. * * Generate crossing event(s) on widget state (sensitivity) or GTK+ grab change. * * The real pointer window is the window that most recently received an enter notify * event. Windows that don't select for crossing events can't become the real * poiner window. The real pointer widget that owns the real pointer window. The * effective pointer window is the same as the real pointer window unless the real * pointer widget is either insensitive or there is a grab on a widget that is not * an ancestor of the real pointer widget (in which case the effective pointer * window should be the root window). * * When the effective pointer window is the same as the real poiner window, we * receive crossing events from the windowing system. When the effective pointer * window changes to become different from the real pointer window we synthesize * crossing events, attempting to follow X protocol rules: * * When the root window becomes the effective pointer window: * - leave notify on real pointer window, detail Ancestor * - leave notify on all of its ancestors, detail Virtual * - enter notify on root window, detail Inferior * * When the root window ceases to be the effective pointer window: * - leave notify on root window, detail Inferior * - enter notify on all ancestors of real pointer window, detail Virtual * - enter notify on real pointer window, detail Ancestor */ void _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing (GtkWidget *from, GtkWidget *to, GdkDevice *device, GdkCrossingMode mode) { GdkWindow *from_window = NULL, *to_window = NULL; g_return_if_fail (from != NULL || to != NULL); if (from != NULL) { from_window = _gtk_widget_get_device_window (from, device); if (!from_window) from_window = from->priv->window; } if (to != NULL) { to_window = _gtk_widget_get_device_window (to, device); if (!to_window) to_window = to->priv->window; } if (from_window == NULL && to_window == NULL) ; else if (from_window != NULL && to_window == NULL) { GList *from_ancestors = NULL, *list; GdkWindow *from_ancestor = from_window; while (from_ancestor != NULL) { from_ancestor = gdk_window_get_effective_parent (from_ancestor); if (from_ancestor == NULL) break; from_ancestors = g_list_prepend (from_ancestors, from_ancestor); } synth_crossing (from, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, from_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_ANCESTOR); for (list = g_list_last (from_ancestors); list; list = list->prev) { synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_VIRTUAL); } /* XXX: enter/inferior on root window? */ g_list_free (from_ancestors); } else if (from_window == NULL && to_window != NULL) { GList *to_ancestors = NULL, *list; GdkWindow *to_ancestor = to_window; while (to_ancestor != NULL) { to_ancestor = gdk_window_get_effective_parent (to_ancestor); if (to_ancestor == NULL) break; to_ancestors = g_list_prepend (to_ancestors, to_ancestor); } /* XXX: leave/inferior on root window? */ for (list = to_ancestors; list; list = list->next) { synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_VIRTUAL); } synth_crossing (to, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, to_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_ANCESTOR); g_list_free (to_ancestors); } else if (from_window == to_window) ; else { GList *from_ancestors = NULL, *to_ancestors = NULL, *list; GdkWindow *from_ancestor = from_window, *to_ancestor = to_window; while (from_ancestor != NULL || to_ancestor != NULL) { if (from_ancestor != NULL) { from_ancestor = gdk_window_get_effective_parent (from_ancestor); if (from_ancestor == to_window) break; if (from_ancestor) from_ancestors = g_list_prepend (from_ancestors, from_ancestor); } if (to_ancestor != NULL) { to_ancestor = gdk_window_get_effective_parent (to_ancestor); if (to_ancestor == from_window) break; if (to_ancestor) to_ancestors = g_list_prepend (to_ancestors, to_ancestor); } } if (to_ancestor == from_window) { if (mode != GDK_CROSSING_GTK_UNGRAB) synth_crossing (from, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, from_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_INFERIOR); for (list = to_ancestors; list; list = list->next) synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_VIRTUAL); synth_crossing (to, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, to_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_ANCESTOR); } else if (from_ancestor == to_window) { synth_crossing (from, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, from_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_ANCESTOR); for (list = g_list_last (from_ancestors); list; list = list->prev) { synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_VIRTUAL); } if (mode != GDK_CROSSING_GTK_GRAB) synth_crossing (to, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, to_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_INFERIOR); } else { while (from_ancestors != NULL && to_ancestors != NULL && from_ancestors->data == to_ancestors->data) { from_ancestors = g_list_delete_link (from_ancestors, from_ancestors); to_ancestors = g_list_delete_link (to_ancestors, to_ancestors); } synth_crossing (from, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, from_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_NONLINEAR); for (list = g_list_last (from_ancestors); list; list = list->prev) { synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_NONLINEAR_VIRTUAL); } for (list = to_ancestors; list; list = list->next) { synth_crossing (NULL, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, (GdkWindow *) list->data, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_NONLINEAR_VIRTUAL); } synth_crossing (to, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, to_window, device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_NONLINEAR); } g_list_free (from_ancestors); g_list_free (to_ancestors); } } static void gtk_widget_propagate_state (GtkWidget *widget, GtkStateData *data) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; GtkStateFlags new_flags, old_flags = priv->state_flags; GtkStateType old_state; old_state = gtk_widget_get_state (widget); switch (data->operation) { case STATE_CHANGE_REPLACE: priv->state_flags = data->flags; break; case STATE_CHANGE_SET: priv->state_flags |= data->flags; break; case STATE_CHANGE_UNSET: priv->state_flags &= ~(data->flags); break; } /* make insensitivity unoverridable */ if (!priv->sensitive) priv->state_flags |= GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE; if (gtk_widget_is_focus (widget) && !gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) { GtkWidget *window; window = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); if (window && gtk_widget_is_toplevel (window)) gtk_window_set_focus (GTK_WINDOW (window), NULL); } new_flags = priv->state_flags; if (old_flags != new_flags) { g_object_ref (widget); if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget) && gtk_widget_has_grab (widget)) gtk_grab_remove (widget); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[STATE_CHANGED], 0, old_state); g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[STATE_FLAGS_CHANGED], 0, old_flags); if (!priv->shadowed) { GList *event_windows = NULL; GList *devices, *d; devices = _gtk_widget_list_devices (widget); for (d = devices; d; d = d->next) { GdkWindow *window; GdkDevice *device; device = d->data; window = _gtk_widget_get_device_window (widget, device); /* Do not propagate more than once to the * same window if non-multidevice aware. */ if (!gdk_window_get_support_multidevice (window) && g_list_find (event_windows, window)) continue; if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing (widget, NULL, d->data, GDK_CROSSING_STATE_CHANGED); else if (old_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing (NULL, widget, d->data, GDK_CROSSING_STATE_CHANGED); event_windows = g_list_prepend (event_windows, window); } g_list_free (event_windows); g_list_free (devices); } if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget)) { GtkStateData child_data = *data; /* Make sure to only propate the right states further */ child_data.flags &= GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_PROPAGATE; if (child_data.use_forall) gtk_container_forall (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), (GtkCallback) gtk_widget_propagate_state, &child_data); else gtk_container_foreach (GTK_CONTAINER (widget), (GtkCallback) gtk_widget_propagate_state, &child_data); } /* Trigger state change transitions for the widget */ if (priv->context && gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) { gint diff, flag = 1; diff = old_flags ^ new_flags; while (diff != 0) { if ((diff & flag) != 0) { gboolean target; target = ((new_flags & flag) != 0); _gtk_widget_notify_state_change (widget, flag, target); diff &= ~flag; } flag <<= 1; } } g_object_unref (widget); } } static const GtkWidgetAuxInfo default_aux_info = { -1, -1, GTK_ALIGN_FILL, GTK_ALIGN_FILL, { 0, 0, 0, 0 } }; /* * gtk_widget_get_aux_info: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @create: if %TRUE, create the structure if it doesn't exist * * Get the #GtkWidgetAuxInfo structure for the widget. * * Return value: the #GtkAuxInfo structure for the widget, or * %NULL if @create is %FALSE and one doesn't already exist. */ static GtkWidgetAuxInfo * gtk_widget_get_aux_info (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean create) { GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info; aux_info = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_aux_info); if (!aux_info && create) { aux_info = g_slice_new0 (GtkWidgetAuxInfo); *aux_info = default_aux_info; g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_aux_info, aux_info); } return aux_info; } static const GtkWidgetAuxInfo* _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info; aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, FALSE); if (aux_info == NULL) { return &default_aux_info; } else { return aux_info; } } /***************************************** * gtk_widget_aux_info_destroy: * * arguments: * * results: *****************************************/ static void gtk_widget_aux_info_destroy (GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info) { g_slice_free (GtkWidgetAuxInfo, aux_info); } /** * gtk_widget_shape_combine_region: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @region: (allow-none): shape to be added, or %NULL to remove an existing shape * * Sets a shape for this widget's GDK window. This allows for * transparent windows etc., see gdk_window_shape_combine_region() * for more information. * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_shape_combine_region (GtkWidget *widget, cairo_region_t *region) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); /* set_shape doesn't work on widgets without gdk window */ g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)); priv = widget->priv; if (region == NULL) { priv->has_shape_mask = FALSE; if (priv->window) gdk_window_shape_combine_region (priv->window, NULL, 0, 0); g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_shape_info, NULL); } else { priv->has_shape_mask = TRUE; g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_shape_info, cairo_region_copy (region), (GDestroyNotify) cairo_region_destroy); /* set shape if widget has a gdk window already. * otherwise the shape is scheduled to be set by gtk_widget_realize(). */ if (priv->window) gdk_window_shape_combine_region (priv->window, region, 0, 0); } } /** * gtk_widget_input_shape_combine_region: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @region: (allow-none): shape to be added, or %NULL to remove an existing shape * * Sets an input shape for this widget's GDK window. This allows for * windows which react to mouse click in a nonrectangular region, see * gdk_window_input_shape_combine_region() for more information. * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_input_shape_combine_region (GtkWidget *widget, cairo_region_t *region) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); /* set_shape doesn't work on widgets without gdk window */ g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)); priv = widget->priv; if (region == NULL) { if (priv->window) gdk_window_input_shape_combine_region (priv->window, NULL, 0, 0); g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info, NULL); } else { g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info, cairo_region_copy (region), (GDestroyNotify) cairo_region_destroy); /* set shape if widget has a gdk window already. * otherwise the shape is scheduled to be set by gtk_widget_realize(). */ if (priv->window) gdk_window_input_shape_combine_region (priv->window, region, 0, 0); } } /* style properties */ /** * gtk_widget_class_install_style_property_parser: (skip) * @klass: a #GtkWidgetClass * @pspec: the #GParamSpec for the style property * @parser: the parser for the style property * * Installs a style property on a widget class. **/ void gtk_widget_class_install_style_property_parser (GtkWidgetClass *klass, GParamSpec *pspec, GtkRcPropertyParser parser) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (klass)); g_return_if_fail (G_IS_PARAM_SPEC (pspec)); g_return_if_fail (pspec->flags & G_PARAM_READABLE); g_return_if_fail (!(pspec->flags & (G_PARAM_CONSTRUCT_ONLY | G_PARAM_CONSTRUCT))); if (g_param_spec_pool_lookup (style_property_spec_pool, pspec->name, G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (klass), FALSE)) { g_warning (G_STRLOC ": class `%s' already contains a style property named `%s'", G_OBJECT_CLASS_NAME (klass), pspec->name); return; } g_param_spec_ref_sink (pspec); g_param_spec_set_qdata (pspec, quark_property_parser, (gpointer) parser); g_param_spec_pool_insert (style_property_spec_pool, pspec, G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (klass)); } /** * gtk_widget_class_install_style_property: * @klass: a #GtkWidgetClass * @pspec: the #GParamSpec for the property * * Installs a style property on a widget class. The parser for the * style property is determined by the value type of @pspec. **/ void gtk_widget_class_install_style_property (GtkWidgetClass *klass, GParamSpec *pspec) { GtkRcPropertyParser parser; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (klass)); g_return_if_fail (G_IS_PARAM_SPEC (pspec)); parser = _gtk_rc_property_parser_from_type (G_PARAM_SPEC_VALUE_TYPE (pspec)); gtk_widget_class_install_style_property_parser (klass, pspec, parser); } /** * gtk_widget_class_find_style_property: * @klass: a #GtkWidgetClass * @property_name: the name of the style property to find * @returns: (transfer none): the #GParamSpec of the style property or * %NULL if @class has no style property with that name. * * Finds a style property of a widget class by name. * * Since: 2.2 */ GParamSpec* gtk_widget_class_find_style_property (GtkWidgetClass *klass, const gchar *property_name) { g_return_val_if_fail (property_name != NULL, NULL); return g_param_spec_pool_lookup (style_property_spec_pool, property_name, G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (klass), TRUE); } /** * gtk_widget_class_list_style_properties: * @klass: a #GtkWidgetClass * @n_properties: location to return the number of style properties found * @returns: (array length=n_properties) (transfer container): an * newly allocated array of #GParamSpec*. The array must be * freed with g_free(). * * Returns all style properties of a widget class. * * Since: 2.2 */ GParamSpec** gtk_widget_class_list_style_properties (GtkWidgetClass *klass, guint *n_properties) { GParamSpec **pspecs; guint n; pspecs = g_param_spec_pool_list (style_property_spec_pool, G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (klass), &n); if (n_properties) *n_properties = n; return pspecs; } /** * gtk_widget_style_get_property: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @property_name: the name of a style property * @value: location to return the property value * * Gets the value of a style property of @widget. */ void gtk_widget_style_get_property (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *property_name, GValue *value) { GParamSpec *pspec; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (property_name != NULL); g_return_if_fail (G_IS_VALUE (value)); g_object_ref (widget); pspec = g_param_spec_pool_lookup (style_property_spec_pool, property_name, G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget), TRUE); if (!pspec) g_warning ("%s: widget class `%s' has no property named `%s'", G_STRLOC, G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), property_name); else { GtkStyleContext *context; const GValue *peek_value; GtkStateFlags state; context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget); state = gtk_widget_get_state_flags (widget); peek_value = _gtk_style_context_peek_style_property (context, G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget), state, pspec); /* auto-conversion of the caller's value type */ if (G_VALUE_TYPE (value) == G_PARAM_SPEC_VALUE_TYPE (pspec)) g_value_copy (peek_value, value); else if (g_value_type_transformable (G_PARAM_SPEC_VALUE_TYPE (pspec), G_VALUE_TYPE (value))) g_value_transform (peek_value, value); else g_warning ("can't retrieve style property `%s' of type `%s' as value of type `%s'", pspec->name, g_type_name (G_PARAM_SPEC_VALUE_TYPE (pspec)), G_VALUE_TYPE_NAME (value)); } g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_style_get_valist: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @first_property_name: the name of the first property to get * @var_args: a va_list of pairs of property names and * locations to return the property values, starting with the location * for @first_property_name. * * Non-vararg variant of gtk_widget_style_get(). Used primarily by language * bindings. */ void gtk_widget_style_get_valist (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *first_property_name, va_list var_args) { GtkStyleContext *context; GtkStateFlags state; const gchar *name; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_object_ref (widget); context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget); state = gtk_widget_get_state_flags (widget); name = first_property_name; while (name) { const GValue *peek_value; GParamSpec *pspec; gchar *error; pspec = g_param_spec_pool_lookup (style_property_spec_pool, name, G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget), TRUE); if (!pspec) { g_warning ("%s: widget class `%s' has no property named `%s'", G_STRLOC, G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), name); break; } /* style pspecs are always readable so we can spare that check here */ peek_value = _gtk_style_context_peek_style_property (context, G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget), state, pspec); G_VALUE_LCOPY (peek_value, var_args, 0, &error); if (error) { g_warning ("%s: %s", G_STRLOC, error); g_free (error); break; } name = va_arg (var_args, gchar*); } g_object_unref (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_style_get: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @first_property_name: the name of the first property to get * @Varargs: pairs of property names and locations to * return the property values, starting with the location for * @first_property_name, terminated by %NULL. * * Gets the values of a multiple style properties of @widget. */ void gtk_widget_style_get (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *first_property_name, ...) { va_list var_args; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); va_start (var_args, first_property_name); gtk_widget_style_get_valist (widget, first_property_name, var_args); va_end (var_args); } /** * gtk_widget_path: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @path_length: (out) (allow-none): location to store length of the path, * or %NULL * @path: (out) (allow-none): location to store allocated path string, * or %NULL * @path_reversed: (out) (allow-none): location to store allocated reverse * path string, or %NULL * * Obtains the full path to @widget. The path is simply the name of a * widget and all its parents in the container hierarchy, separated by * periods. The name of a widget comes from * gtk_widget_get_name(). Paths are used to apply styles to a widget * in gtkrc configuration files. Widget names are the type of the * widget by default (e.g. "GtkButton") or can be set to an * application-specific value with gtk_widget_set_name(). By setting * the name of a widget, you allow users or theme authors to apply * styles to that specific widget in their gtkrc * file. @path_reversed_p fills in the path in reverse order, * i.e. starting with @widget's name instead of starting with the name * of @widget's outermost ancestor. * * Deprecated:3.0: Use gtk_widget_get_path() instead **/ void gtk_widget_path (GtkWidget *widget, guint *path_length, gchar **path, gchar **path_reversed) { static gchar *rev_path = NULL; static guint tmp_path_len = 0; guint len; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); len = 0; do { const gchar *string; const gchar *s; gchar *d; guint l; string = gtk_widget_get_name (widget); l = strlen (string); while (tmp_path_len <= len + l + 1) { tmp_path_len += INIT_PATH_SIZE; rev_path = g_realloc (rev_path, tmp_path_len); } s = string + l - 1; d = rev_path + len; while (s >= string) *(d++) = *(s--); len += l; widget = widget->priv->parent; if (widget) rev_path[len++] = '.'; else rev_path[len++] = 0; } while (widget); if (path_length) *path_length = len - 1; if (path_reversed) *path_reversed = g_strdup (rev_path); if (path) { *path = g_strdup (rev_path); g_strreverse (*path); } } /** * gtk_widget_class_path: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @path_length: (out) (allow-none): location to store the length of the * class path, or %NULL * @path: (out) (allow-none): location to store the class path as an * allocated string, or %NULL * @path_reversed: (out) (allow-none): location to store the reverse * class path as an allocated string, or %NULL * * Same as gtk_widget_path(), but always uses the name of a widget's type, * never uses a custom name set with gtk_widget_set_name(). * * Deprecated:3.0: Use gtk_widget_get_path() instead **/ void gtk_widget_class_path (GtkWidget *widget, guint *path_length, gchar **path, gchar **path_reversed) { static gchar *rev_path = NULL; static guint tmp_path_len = 0; guint len; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); len = 0; do { const gchar *string; const gchar *s; gchar *d; guint l; string = g_type_name (G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget)); l = strlen (string); while (tmp_path_len <= len + l + 1) { tmp_path_len += INIT_PATH_SIZE; rev_path = g_realloc (rev_path, tmp_path_len); } s = string + l - 1; d = rev_path + len; while (s >= string) *(d++) = *(s--); len += l; widget = widget->priv->parent; if (widget) rev_path[len++] = '.'; else rev_path[len++] = 0; } while (widget); if (path_length) *path_length = len - 1; if (path_reversed) *path_reversed = g_strdup (rev_path); if (path) { *path = g_strdup (rev_path); g_strreverse (*path); } } /** * gtk_requisition_new: * * Allocates a new #GtkRequisition structure and initializes its elements to zero. * * Returns: a new empty #GtkRequisition. The newly allocated #GtkRequisition should * be freed with gtk_requisition_free(). * * Since: 3.0 */ GtkRequisition * gtk_requisition_new (void) { return g_slice_new0 (GtkRequisition); } /** * gtk_requisition_copy: * @requisition: a #GtkRequisition * * Copies a #GtkRequisition. * * Returns: a copy of @requisition **/ GtkRequisition * gtk_requisition_copy (const GtkRequisition *requisition) { return g_slice_dup (GtkRequisition, requisition); } /** * gtk_requisition_free: * @requisition: a #GtkRequisition * * Frees a #GtkRequisition. **/ void gtk_requisition_free (GtkRequisition *requisition) { g_slice_free (GtkRequisition, requisition); } G_DEFINE_BOXED_TYPE (GtkRequisition, gtk_requisition, gtk_requisition_copy, gtk_requisition_free) /** * gtk_widget_get_accessible: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the accessible object that describes the widget to an * assistive technology. * * If no accessibility library is loaded (i.e. no ATK implementation library is * loaded via GTK_MODULES or via another application library, * such as libgnome), then this #AtkObject instance may be a no-op. Likewise, * if no class-specific #AtkObject implementation is available for the widget * instance in question, it will inherit an #AtkObject implementation from the * first ancestor class for which such an implementation is defined. * * The documentation of the * ATK * library contains more information about accessible objects and their uses. * * Returns: (transfer none): the #AtkObject associated with @widget */ AtkObject* gtk_widget_get_accessible (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetClass *klass; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); klass = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget); g_return_val_if_fail (klass->get_accessible != NULL, NULL); return klass->get_accessible (widget); } static AtkObject* gtk_widget_real_get_accessible (GtkWidget *widget) { AtkObject* accessible; accessible = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accessible_object); if (!accessible) { AtkObjectFactory *factory; AtkRegistry *default_registry; default_registry = atk_get_default_registry (); factory = atk_registry_get_factory (default_registry, G_TYPE_FROM_INSTANCE (widget)); accessible = atk_object_factory_create_accessible (factory, G_OBJECT (widget)); g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accessible_object, accessible); } return accessible; } /* * Initialize a AtkImplementorIface instance's virtual pointers as * appropriate to this implementor's class (GtkWidget). */ static void gtk_widget_accessible_interface_init (AtkImplementorIface *iface) { iface->ref_accessible = gtk_widget_ref_accessible; } static AtkObject* gtk_widget_ref_accessible (AtkImplementor *implementor) { AtkObject *accessible; accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (implementor)); if (accessible) g_object_ref (accessible); return accessible; } /* * Expand flag management */ static void gtk_widget_update_computed_expand (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; priv = widget->priv; if (priv->need_compute_expand) { gboolean h, v; if (priv->hexpand_set) h = priv->hexpand; else h = FALSE; if (priv->vexpand_set) v = priv->vexpand; else v = FALSE; /* we don't need to use compute_expand if both expands are * forced by the app */ if (!(priv->hexpand_set && priv->vexpand_set)) { if (GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->compute_expand != NULL) { gboolean ignored; GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->compute_expand (widget, priv->hexpand_set ? &ignored : &h, priv->vexpand_set ? &ignored : &v); } } priv->need_compute_expand = FALSE; priv->computed_hexpand = h != FALSE; priv->computed_vexpand = v != FALSE; } } /** * gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Mark @widget as needing to recompute its expand flags. Call * this function when setting legacy expand child properties * on the child of a container. * * See gtk_widget_compute_expand(). */ void gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidget *parent; gboolean changed_anything; if (widget->priv->need_compute_expand) return; changed_anything = FALSE; parent = widget; while (parent != NULL) { if (!parent->priv->need_compute_expand) { parent->priv->need_compute_expand = TRUE; changed_anything = TRUE; } /* Note: if we had an invariant that "if a child needs to * compute expand, its parents also do" then we could stop going * up when we got to a parent that already needed to * compute. However, in general we compute expand lazily (as * soon as we see something in a subtree that is expand, we know * we're expanding) and so this invariant does not hold and we * have to always walk all the way up in case some ancestor * is not currently need_compute_expand. */ parent = parent->priv->parent; } /* recomputing expand always requires * a relayout as well */ if (changed_anything) gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_compute_expand: * @widget: the widget * @orientation: expand direction * * Computes whether a container should give this widget extra space * when possible. Containers should check this, rather than * looking at gtk_widget_get_hexpand() or gtk_widget_get_vexpand(). * * This function already checks whether the widget is visible, so * visibility does not need to be checked separately. Non-visible * widgets are not expanded. * * The computed expand value uses either the expand setting explicitly * set on the widget itself, or, if none has been explicitly set, * the widget may expand if some of its children do. * * Return value: whether widget tree rooted here should be expanded */ gboolean gtk_widget_compute_expand (GtkWidget *widget, GtkOrientation orientation) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); /* We never make a widget expand if not even showing. */ if (!gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) return FALSE; gtk_widget_update_computed_expand (widget); if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) { return widget->priv->computed_hexpand; } else { return widget->priv->computed_vexpand; } } static void gtk_widget_set_expand (GtkWidget *widget, GtkOrientation orientation, gboolean expand) { const char *expand_prop; const char *expand_set_prop; gboolean was_both; GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; expand = expand != FALSE; was_both = priv->hexpand && priv->vexpand; if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) { if (priv->hexpand_set && priv->hexpand == expand) return; priv->hexpand_set = TRUE; priv->hexpand = expand; expand_prop = "hexpand"; expand_set_prop = "hexpand-set"; } else { if (priv->vexpand_set && priv->vexpand == expand) return; priv->vexpand_set = TRUE; priv->vexpand = expand; expand_prop = "vexpand"; expand_set_prop = "vexpand-set"; } gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (widget); g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), expand_prop); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), expand_set_prop); if (was_both != (priv->hexpand && priv->vexpand)) g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "expand"); g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); } static void gtk_widget_set_expand_set (GtkWidget *widget, GtkOrientation orientation, gboolean set) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; const char *prop; priv = widget->priv; set = set != FALSE; if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) { if (set == priv->hexpand_set) return; priv->hexpand_set = set; prop = "hexpand-set"; } else { if (set == priv->vexpand_set) return; priv->vexpand_set = set; prop = "vexpand-set"; } gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (widget); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), prop); } /** * gtk_widget_get_hexpand: * @widget: the widget * * Gets whether the widget would like any available extra horizontal * space. When a user resizes a #GtkWindow, widgets with expand=TRUE * generally receive the extra space. For example, a list or * scrollable area or document in your window would often be set to * expand. * * Containers should use gtk_widget_compute_expand() rather than * this function, to see whether a widget, or any of its children, * has the expand flag set. If any child of a widget wants to * expand, the parent may ask to expand also. * * This function only looks at the widget's own hexpand flag, rather * than computing whether the entire widget tree rooted at this widget * wants to expand. * * Return value: whether hexpand flag is set */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_hexpand (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->hexpand; } /** * gtk_widget_set_hexpand: * @widget: the widget * @expand: whether to expand * * Sets whether the widget would like any available extra horizontal * space. When a user resizes a #GtkWindow, widgets with expand=TRUE * generally receive the extra space. For example, a list or * scrollable area or document in your window would often be set to * expand. * * Call this function to set the expand flag if you would like your * widget to become larger horizontally when the window has extra * room. * * By default, widgets automatically expand if any of their children * want to expand. (To see if a widget will automatically expand given * its current children and state, call gtk_widget_compute_expand(). A * container can decide how the expandability of children affects the * expansion of the container by overriding the compute_expand virtual * method on #GtkWidget.). * * Setting hexpand explicitly with this function will override the * automatic expand behavior. * * This function forces the widget to expand or not to expand, * regardless of children. The override occurs because * gtk_widget_set_hexpand() sets the hexpand-set property (see * gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set()) which causes the widget's hexpand * value to be used, rather than looking at children and widget state. */ void gtk_widget_set_hexpand (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean expand) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_set_expand (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, expand); } /** * gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set: * @widget: the widget * * Gets whether gtk_widget_set_hexpand() has been used to * explicitly set the expand flag on this widget. * * If hexpand is set, then it overrides any computed * expand value based on child widgets. If hexpand is not * set, then the expand value depends on whether any * children of the widget would like to expand. * * There are few reasons to use this function, but it's here * for completeness and consistency. * * Return value: whether hexpand has been explicitly set */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->hexpand_set; } /** * gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set: * @widget: the widget * @set: value for hexpand-set property * * Sets whether the hexpand flag (see gtk_widget_get_hexpand()) will * be used. * * The hexpand-set property will be set automatically when you call * gtk_widget_set_hexpand() to set hexpand, so the most likely * reason to use this function would be to unset an explicit expand * flag. * * If hexpand is set, then it overrides any computed * expand value based on child widgets. If hexpand is not * set, then the expand value depends on whether any * children of the widget would like to expand. * * There are few reasons to use this function, but it's here * for completeness and consistency. */ void gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean set) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_set_expand_set (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, set); } /** * gtk_widget_get_vexpand: * @widget: the widget * * Gets whether the widget would like any available extra vertical * space. * * See gtk_widget_get_hexpand() for more detail. * * Return value: whether vexpand flag is set */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_vexpand (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->vexpand; } /** * gtk_widget_set_vexpand: * @widget: the widget * @expand: whether to expand * * Sets whether the widget would like any available extra vertical * space. * * See gtk_widget_set_hexpand() for more detail. */ void gtk_widget_set_vexpand (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean expand) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_set_expand (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, expand); } /** * gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set: * @widget: the widget * * Gets whether gtk_widget_set_vexpand() has been used to * explicitly set the expand flag on this widget. * * See gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set() for more detail. * * Return value: whether vexpand has been explicitly set */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->vexpand_set; } /** * gtk_widget_set_vexpand_set: * @widget: the widget * @set: value for vexpand-set property * * Sets whether the vexpand flag (see gtk_widget_get_vexpand()) will * be used. * * See gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set() for more detail. */ void gtk_widget_set_vexpand_set (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean set) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); gtk_widget_set_expand_set (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, set); } /* * GtkBuildable implementation */ static GQuark quark_builder_has_default = 0; static GQuark quark_builder_has_focus = 0; static GQuark quark_builder_atk_relations = 0; static GQuark quark_builder_set_name = 0; static void gtk_widget_buildable_interface_init (GtkBuildableIface *iface) { quark_builder_has_default = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-builder-has-default"); quark_builder_has_focus = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-builder-has-focus"); quark_builder_atk_relations = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-builder-atk-relations"); quark_builder_set_name = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-builder-set-name"); iface->set_name = gtk_widget_buildable_set_name; iface->get_name = gtk_widget_buildable_get_name; iface->get_internal_child = gtk_widget_buildable_get_internal_child; iface->set_buildable_property = gtk_widget_buildable_set_buildable_property; iface->parser_finished = gtk_widget_buildable_parser_finished; iface->custom_tag_start = gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_start; iface->custom_finished = gtk_widget_buildable_custom_finished; } static void gtk_widget_buildable_set_name (GtkBuildable *buildable, const gchar *name) { g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_set_name, g_strdup (name), g_free); } static const gchar * gtk_widget_buildable_get_name (GtkBuildable *buildable) { return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_set_name); } static GObject * gtk_widget_buildable_get_internal_child (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, const gchar *childname) { if (strcmp (childname, "accessible") == 0) return G_OBJECT (gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (buildable))); return NULL; } static void gtk_widget_buildable_set_buildable_property (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, const gchar *name, const GValue *value) { if (strcmp (name, "has-default") == 0 && g_value_get_boolean (value)) g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_has_default, GINT_TO_POINTER (TRUE)); else if (strcmp (name, "has-focus") == 0 && g_value_get_boolean (value)) g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_has_focus, GINT_TO_POINTER (TRUE)); else g_object_set_property (G_OBJECT (buildable), name, value); } typedef struct { gchar *action_name; GString *description; gchar *context; gboolean translatable; } AtkActionData; typedef struct { gchar *target; gchar *type; } AtkRelationData; static void free_action (AtkActionData *data, gpointer user_data) { g_free (data->action_name); g_string_free (data->description, TRUE); g_free (data->context); g_slice_free (AtkActionData, data); } static void free_relation (AtkRelationData *data, gpointer user_data) { g_free (data->target); g_free (data->type); g_slice_free (AtkRelationData, data); } static void gtk_widget_buildable_parser_finished (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder) { GSList *atk_relations; if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_has_default)) gtk_widget_grab_default (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_has_focus)) gtk_widget_grab_focus (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); atk_relations = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_atk_relations); if (atk_relations) { AtkObject *accessible; AtkRelationSet *relation_set; GSList *l; GObject *target; AtkRelationType relation_type; AtkObject *target_accessible; accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); relation_set = atk_object_ref_relation_set (accessible); for (l = atk_relations; l; l = l->next) { AtkRelationData *relation = (AtkRelationData*)l->data; target = gtk_builder_get_object (builder, relation->target); if (!target) { g_warning ("Target object %s in does not exist", relation->target); continue; } target_accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (target)); g_assert (target_accessible != NULL); relation_type = atk_relation_type_for_name (relation->type); if (relation_type == ATK_RELATION_NULL) { g_warning (" type %s not found", relation->type); continue; } atk_relation_set_add_relation_by_type (relation_set, relation_type, target_accessible); } g_object_unref (relation_set); g_slist_foreach (atk_relations, (GFunc)free_relation, NULL); g_slist_free (atk_relations); g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_atk_relations, NULL); } } typedef struct { GSList *actions; GSList *relations; } AccessibilitySubParserData; static void accessibility_start_element (GMarkupParseContext *context, const gchar *element_name, const gchar **names, const gchar **values, gpointer user_data, GError **error) { AccessibilitySubParserData *data = (AccessibilitySubParserData*)user_data; guint i; gint line_number, char_number; if (strcmp (element_name, "relation") == 0) { gchar *target = NULL; gchar *type = NULL; AtkRelationData *relation; for (i = 0; names[i]; i++) { if (strcmp (names[i], "target") == 0) target = g_strdup (values[i]); else if (strcmp (names[i], "type") == 0) type = g_strdup (values[i]); else { g_markup_parse_context_get_position (context, &line_number, &char_number); g_set_error (error, GTK_BUILDER_ERROR, GTK_BUILDER_ERROR_INVALID_ATTRIBUTE, "%s:%d:%d '%s' is not a valid attribute of <%s>", "", line_number, char_number, names[i], "relation"); g_free (target); g_free (type); return; } } if (!target || !type) { g_markup_parse_context_get_position (context, &line_number, &char_number); g_set_error (error, GTK_BUILDER_ERROR, GTK_BUILDER_ERROR_MISSING_ATTRIBUTE, "%s:%d:%d <%s> requires attribute \"%s\"", "", line_number, char_number, "relation", type ? "target" : "type"); g_free (target); g_free (type); return; } relation = g_slice_new (AtkRelationData); relation->target = target; relation->type = type; data->relations = g_slist_prepend (data->relations, relation); } else if (strcmp (element_name, "action") == 0) { const gchar *action_name = NULL; const gchar *description = NULL; const gchar *msg_context = NULL; gboolean translatable = FALSE; AtkActionData *action; for (i = 0; names[i]; i++) { if (strcmp (names[i], "action_name") == 0) action_name = values[i]; else if (strcmp (names[i], "description") == 0) description = values[i]; else if (strcmp (names[i], "translatable") == 0) { if (!_gtk_builder_boolean_from_string (values[i], &translatable, error)) return; } else if (strcmp (names[i], "comments") == 0) { /* do nothing, comments are for translators */ } else if (strcmp (names[i], "context") == 0) msg_context = values[i]; else { g_markup_parse_context_get_position (context, &line_number, &char_number); g_set_error (error, GTK_BUILDER_ERROR, GTK_BUILDER_ERROR_INVALID_ATTRIBUTE, "%s:%d:%d '%s' is not a valid attribute of <%s>", "", line_number, char_number, names[i], "action"); return; } } if (!action_name) { g_markup_parse_context_get_position (context, &line_number, &char_number); g_set_error (error, GTK_BUILDER_ERROR, GTK_BUILDER_ERROR_MISSING_ATTRIBUTE, "%s:%d:%d <%s> requires attribute \"%s\"", "", line_number, char_number, "action", "action_name"); return; } action = g_slice_new (AtkActionData); action->action_name = g_strdup (action_name); action->description = g_string_new (description); action->context = g_strdup (msg_context); action->translatable = translatable; data->actions = g_slist_prepend (data->actions, action); } else if (strcmp (element_name, "accessibility") == 0) ; else g_warning ("Unsupported tag for GtkWidget: %s\n", element_name); } static void accessibility_text (GMarkupParseContext *context, const gchar *text, gsize text_len, gpointer user_data, GError **error) { AccessibilitySubParserData *data = (AccessibilitySubParserData*)user_data; if (strcmp (g_markup_parse_context_get_element (context), "action") == 0) { AtkActionData *action = data->actions->data; g_string_append_len (action->description, text, text_len); } } static const GMarkupParser accessibility_parser = { accessibility_start_element, NULL, accessibility_text, }; typedef struct { GObject *object; guint key; guint modifiers; gchar *signal; } AccelGroupParserData; static void accel_group_start_element (GMarkupParseContext *context, const gchar *element_name, const gchar **names, const gchar **values, gpointer user_data, GError **error) { gint i; guint key = 0; guint modifiers = 0; gchar *signal = NULL; AccelGroupParserData *parser_data = (AccelGroupParserData*)user_data; for (i = 0; names[i]; i++) { if (strcmp (names[i], "key") == 0) key = gdk_keyval_from_name (values[i]); else if (strcmp (names[i], "modifiers") == 0) { if (!_gtk_builder_flags_from_string (GDK_TYPE_MODIFIER_TYPE, values[i], &modifiers, error)) return; } else if (strcmp (names[i], "signal") == 0) signal = g_strdup (values[i]); } if (key == 0 || signal == NULL) { g_warning (" requires key and signal attributes"); return; } parser_data->key = key; parser_data->modifiers = modifiers; parser_data->signal = signal; } static const GMarkupParser accel_group_parser = { accel_group_start_element, }; typedef struct { GSList *classes; } StyleParserData; static void style_start_element (GMarkupParseContext *context, const gchar *element_name, const gchar **names, const gchar **values, gpointer user_data, GError **error) { StyleParserData *style_data = (StyleParserData *)user_data; gchar *class_name; if (strcmp (element_name, "class") == 0) { if (g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRDUP, "name", &class_name, G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) { style_data->classes = g_slist_append (style_data->classes, class_name); } } else if (strcmp (element_name, "style") == 0) ; else g_warning ("Unsupported tag for GtkWidget: %s\n", element_name); } static const GMarkupParser style_parser = { style_start_element, }; static gboolean gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_start (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, GObject *child, const gchar *tagname, GMarkupParser *parser, gpointer *data) { g_assert (buildable); if (strcmp (tagname, "accelerator") == 0) { AccelGroupParserData *parser_data; parser_data = g_slice_new0 (AccelGroupParserData); parser_data->object = g_object_ref (buildable); *parser = accel_group_parser; *data = parser_data; return TRUE; } if (strcmp (tagname, "accessibility") == 0) { AccessibilitySubParserData *parser_data; parser_data = g_slice_new0 (AccessibilitySubParserData); *parser = accessibility_parser; *data = parser_data; return TRUE; } if (strcmp (tagname, "style") == 0) { StyleParserData *parser_data; parser_data = g_slice_new0 (StyleParserData); *parser = style_parser; *data = parser_data; return TRUE; } return FALSE; } void _gtk_widget_buildable_finish_accelerator (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *toplevel, gpointer user_data) { AccelGroupParserData *accel_data; GSList *accel_groups; GtkAccelGroup *accel_group; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (toplevel)); g_return_if_fail (user_data != NULL); accel_data = (AccelGroupParserData*)user_data; accel_groups = gtk_accel_groups_from_object (G_OBJECT (toplevel)); if (g_slist_length (accel_groups) == 0) { accel_group = gtk_accel_group_new (); gtk_window_add_accel_group (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), accel_group); } else { g_assert (g_slist_length (accel_groups) == 1); accel_group = g_slist_nth_data (accel_groups, 0); } gtk_widget_add_accelerator (GTK_WIDGET (accel_data->object), accel_data->signal, accel_group, accel_data->key, accel_data->modifiers, GTK_ACCEL_VISIBLE); g_object_unref (accel_data->object); g_free (accel_data->signal); g_slice_free (AccelGroupParserData, accel_data); } static void gtk_widget_buildable_custom_finished (GtkBuildable *buildable, GtkBuilder *builder, GObject *child, const gchar *tagname, gpointer user_data) { if (strcmp (tagname, "accelerator") == 0) { AccelGroupParserData *accel_data; GtkWidget *toplevel; accel_data = (AccelGroupParserData*)user_data; g_assert (accel_data->object); toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (GTK_WIDGET (accel_data->object)); _gtk_widget_buildable_finish_accelerator (GTK_WIDGET (buildable), toplevel, user_data); } else if (strcmp (tagname, "accessibility") == 0) { AccessibilitySubParserData *a11y_data; a11y_data = (AccessibilitySubParserData*)user_data; if (a11y_data->actions) { AtkObject *accessible; AtkAction *action; gint i, n_actions; GSList *l; accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); if (ATK_IS_ACTION (accessible)) { action = ATK_ACTION (accessible); n_actions = atk_action_get_n_actions (action); for (l = a11y_data->actions; l; l = l->next) { AtkActionData *action_data = (AtkActionData*)l->data; for (i = 0; i < n_actions; i++) if (strcmp (atk_action_get_name (action, i), action_data->action_name) == 0) break; if (i < n_actions) { gchar *description; if (action_data->translatable && action_data->description->len) description = _gtk_builder_parser_translate (gtk_builder_get_translation_domain (builder), action_data->context, action_data->description->str); else description = action_data->description->str; atk_action_set_description (action, i, description); } } } else g_warning ("accessibility action on a widget that does not implement AtkAction"); g_slist_foreach (a11y_data->actions, (GFunc)free_action, NULL); g_slist_free (a11y_data->actions); } if (a11y_data->relations) g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_atk_relations, a11y_data->relations); g_slice_free (AccessibilitySubParserData, a11y_data); } else if (strcmp (tagname, "style") == 0) { StyleParserData *style_data = (StyleParserData *)user_data; GtkStyleContext *context; GSList *l; context = gtk_widget_get_style_context (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); for (l = style_data->classes; l; l = l->next) gtk_style_context_add_class (context, (const gchar *)l->data); gtk_widget_reset_style (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); g_slist_free_full (style_data->classes, g_free); g_slice_free (StyleParserData, style_data); } } static GtkSizeRequestMode gtk_widget_real_get_request_mode (GtkWidget *widget) { /* By default widgets dont trade size at all. */ return GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_CONSTANT_SIZE; } static void gtk_widget_real_get_width (GtkWidget *widget, gint *minimum_size, gint *natural_size) { if (minimum_size) *minimum_size = 0; if (natural_size) *natural_size = 0; } static void gtk_widget_real_get_height (GtkWidget *widget, gint *minimum_size, gint *natural_size) { if (minimum_size) *minimum_size = 0; if (natural_size) *natural_size = 0; } static void gtk_widget_real_get_height_for_width (GtkWidget *widget, gint width, gint *minimum_height, gint *natural_height) { GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->get_preferred_height (widget, minimum_height, natural_height); } static void gtk_widget_real_get_width_for_height (GtkWidget *widget, gint height, gint *minimum_width, gint *natural_width) { GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->get_preferred_width (widget, minimum_width, natural_width); } /** * gtk_widget_get_halign: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:halign property. * * Returns: the horizontal alignment of @widget */ GtkAlign gtk_widget_get_halign (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_ALIGN_FILL); return _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget)->halign; } /** * gtk_widget_set_halign: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @align: the horizontal alignment * * Sets the horizontal alignment of @widget. * See the #GtkWidget:halign property. */ void gtk_widget_set_halign (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAlign align) { GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, TRUE); if (aux_info->halign == align) return; aux_info->halign = align; gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "halign"); } /** * gtk_widget_get_valign: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:valign property. * * Returns: the vertical alignment of @widget */ GtkAlign gtk_widget_get_valign (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_ALIGN_FILL); return _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget)->valign; } /** * gtk_widget_set_valign: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @align: the vertical alignment * * Sets the vertical alignment of @widget. * See the #GtkWidget:valign property. */ void gtk_widget_set_valign (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAlign align) { GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, TRUE); if (aux_info->valign == align) return; aux_info->valign = align; gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "valign"); } /** * gtk_widget_get_margin_left: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-left property. * * Returns: The left margin of @widget * * Since: 3.0 */ gint gtk_widget_get_margin_left (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget)->margin.left; } /** * gtk_widget_set_margin_left: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @margin: the left margin * * Sets the left margin of @widget. * See the #GtkWidget:margin-left property. * * Since: 3.0 */ void gtk_widget_set_margin_left (GtkWidget *widget, gint margin) { GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16); aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, TRUE); if (aux_info->margin.left == margin) return; aux_info->margin.left = margin; gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "margin-left"); } /** * gtk_widget_get_margin_right: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-right property. * * Returns: The right margin of @widget * * Since: 3.0 */ gint gtk_widget_get_margin_right (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget)->margin.right; } /** * gtk_widget_set_margin_right: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @margin: the right margin * * Sets the right margin of @widget. * See the #GtkWidget:margin-right property. * * Since: 3.0 */ void gtk_widget_set_margin_right (GtkWidget *widget, gint margin) { GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16); aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, TRUE); if (aux_info->margin.right == margin) return; aux_info->margin.right = margin; gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "margin-right"); } /** * gtk_widget_get_margin_top: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-top property. * * Returns: The top margin of @widget * * Since: 3.0 */ gint gtk_widget_get_margin_top (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget)->margin.top; } /** * gtk_widget_set_margin_top: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @margin: the top margin * * Sets the top margin of @widget. * See the #GtkWidget:margin-top property. * * Since: 3.0 */ void gtk_widget_set_margin_top (GtkWidget *widget, gint margin) { GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16); aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, TRUE); if (aux_info->margin.top == margin) return; aux_info->margin.top = margin; gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "margin-top"); } /** * gtk_widget_get_margin_bottom: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-bottom property. * * Returns: The bottom margin of @widget * * Since: 3.0 */ gint gtk_widget_get_margin_bottom (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return _gtk_widget_get_aux_info_or_defaults (widget)->margin.bottom; } /** * gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @margin: the bottom margin * * Sets the bottom margin of @widget. * See the #GtkWidget:margin-bottom property. * * Since: 3.0 */ void gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom (GtkWidget *widget, gint margin) { GtkWidgetAuxInfo *aux_info; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16); aux_info = gtk_widget_get_aux_info (widget, TRUE); if (aux_info->margin.bottom == margin) return; aux_info->margin.bottom = margin; gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "margin-bottom"); } /** * gtk_widget_get_clipboard: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @selection: a #GdkAtom which identifies the clipboard * to use. %GDK_SELECTION_CLIPBOARD gives the * default clipboard. Another common value * is %GDK_SELECTION_PRIMARY, which gives * the primary X selection. * * Returns the clipboard object for the given selection to * be used with @widget. @widget must have a #GdkDisplay * associated with it, so must be attached to a toplevel * window. * * Return value: (transfer none): the appropriate clipboard object. If no * clipboard already exists, a new one will * be created. Once a clipboard object has * been created, it is persistent for all time. * * Since: 2.2 **/ GtkClipboard * gtk_widget_get_clipboard (GtkWidget *widget, GdkAtom selection) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); g_return_val_if_fail (gtk_widget_has_screen (widget), NULL); return gtk_clipboard_get_for_display (gtk_widget_get_display (widget), selection); } /** * gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns a newly allocated list of the widgets, normally labels, for * which this widget is the target of a mnemonic (see for example, * gtk_label_set_mnemonic_widget()). * The widgets in the list are not individually referenced. If you * want to iterate through the list and perform actions involving * callbacks that might destroy the widgets, you * must call g_list_foreach (result, * (GFunc)g_object_ref, NULL) first, and then unref all the * widgets afterwards. * Return value: (element-type GtkWidget) (transfer container): the list of * mnemonic labels; free this list * with g_list_free() when you are done with it. * * Since: 2.4 **/ GList * gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels (GtkWidget *widget) { GList *list = NULL; GSList *l; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); for (l = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels); l; l = l->next) list = g_list_prepend (list, l->data); return list; } /** * gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @label: a #GtkWidget that acts as a mnemonic label for @widget * * Adds a widget to the list of mnemonic labels for * this widget. (See gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels()). Note the * list of mnemonic labels for the widget is cleared when the * widget is destroyed, so the caller must make sure to update * its internal state at this point as well, by using a connection * to the #GtkWidget::destroy signal or a weak notifier. * * Since: 2.4 **/ void gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *label) { GSList *old_list, *new_list; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (label)); old_list = g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels); new_list = g_slist_prepend (old_list, label); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels, new_list, (GDestroyNotify) g_slist_free); } /** * gtk_widget_remove_mnemonic_label: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @label: a #GtkWidget that was previously set as a mnemnic label for * @widget with gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label(). * * Removes a widget from the list of mnemonic labels for * this widget. (See gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels()). The widget * must have previously been added to the list with * gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label(). * * Since: 2.4 **/ void gtk_widget_remove_mnemonic_label (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWidget *label) { GSList *old_list, *new_list; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (label)); old_list = g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels); new_list = g_slist_remove (old_list, label); if (new_list) g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels, new_list, (GDestroyNotify) g_slist_free); } /** * gtk_widget_get_no_show_all: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the current value of the #GtkWidget:no-show-all property, * which determines whether calls to gtk_widget_show_all() * will affect this widget. * * Return value: the current value of the "no-show-all" property. * * Since: 2.4 **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_no_show_all (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->no_show_all; } /** * gtk_widget_set_no_show_all: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @no_show_all: the new value for the "no-show-all" property * * Sets the #GtkWidget:no-show-all property, which determines whether * calls to gtk_widget_show_all() will affect this widget. * * This is mostly for use in constructing widget hierarchies with externally * controlled visibility, see #GtkUIManager. * * Since: 2.4 **/ void gtk_widget_set_no_show_all (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean no_show_all) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); no_show_all = (no_show_all != FALSE); if (widget->priv->no_show_all != no_show_all) { widget->priv->no_show_all = no_show_all; g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "no-show-all"); } } static void gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean has_tooltip, gboolean force) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = widget->priv; gboolean priv_has_tooltip; priv_has_tooltip = GPOINTER_TO_UINT (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_has_tooltip)); if (priv_has_tooltip != has_tooltip || force) { priv_has_tooltip = has_tooltip; if (priv_has_tooltip) { if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget) && !gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) gdk_window_set_events (priv->window, gdk_window_get_events (priv->window) | GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY_MASK | GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK | GDK_POINTER_MOTION_HINT_MASK); if (gtk_widget_get_has_window (widget)) gtk_widget_add_events (widget, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY_MASK | GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK | GDK_POINTER_MOTION_HINT_MASK); } g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_has_tooltip, GUINT_TO_POINTER (priv_has_tooltip)); } } /** * gtk_widget_set_tooltip_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @custom_window: (allow-none): a #GtkWindow, or %NULL * * Replaces the default, usually yellow, window used for displaying * tooltips with @custom_window. GTK+ will take care of showing and * hiding @custom_window at the right moment, to behave likewise as * the default tooltip window. If @custom_window is %NULL, the default * tooltip window will be used. * * If the custom window should have the default theming it needs to * have the name "gtk-tooltip", see gtk_widget_set_name(). * * Since: 2.12 */ void gtk_widget_set_tooltip_window (GtkWidget *widget, GtkWindow *custom_window) { gboolean has_tooltip; gchar *tooltip_markup; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (custom_window == NULL || GTK_IS_WINDOW (custom_window)); tooltip_markup = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_markup); if (custom_window) g_object_ref (custom_window); g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_window, custom_window, g_object_unref); has_tooltip = (custom_window != NULL || tooltip_markup != NULL); gtk_widget_real_set_has_tooltip (widget, has_tooltip, FALSE); if (has_tooltip && gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the #GtkWindow of the current tooltip. This can be the * GtkWindow created by default, or the custom tooltip window set * using gtk_widget_set_tooltip_window(). * * Return value: (transfer none): The #GtkWindow of the current tooltip. * * Since: 2.12 */ GtkWindow * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_window (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_window); } /** * gtk_widget_trigger_tooltip_query: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Triggers a tooltip query on the display where the toplevel of @widget * is located. See gtk_tooltip_trigger_tooltip_query() for more * information. * * Since: 2.12 */ void gtk_widget_trigger_tooltip_query (GtkWidget *widget) { gtk_tooltip_trigger_tooltip_query (gtk_widget_get_display (widget)); } static guint tooltip_query_id; static GSList *tooltip_query_displays; static gboolean tooltip_query_idle (gpointer data) { g_slist_foreach (tooltip_query_displays, (GFunc)gtk_tooltip_trigger_tooltip_query, NULL); g_slist_foreach (tooltip_query_displays, (GFunc)g_object_unref, NULL); g_slist_free (tooltip_query_displays); tooltip_query_displays = NULL; tooltip_query_id = 0; return FALSE; } static void gtk_widget_queue_tooltip_query (GtkWidget *widget) { GdkDisplay *display; display = gtk_widget_get_display (widget); if (!g_slist_find (tooltip_query_displays, display)) tooltip_query_displays = g_slist_prepend (tooltip_query_displays, g_object_ref (display)); if (tooltip_query_id == 0) tooltip_query_id = gdk_threads_add_idle (tooltip_query_idle, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_set_tooltip_text: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @text: the contents of the tooltip for @widget * * Sets @text as the contents of the tooltip. This function will take * care of setting #GtkWidget:has-tooltip to %TRUE and of the default * handler for the #GtkWidget::query-tooltip signal. * * See also the #GtkWidget:tooltip-text property and gtk_tooltip_set_text(). * * Since: 2.12 */ void gtk_widget_set_tooltip_text (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *text) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_object_set (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-text", text, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_text: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the contents of the tooltip for @widget. * * Return value: the tooltip text, or %NULL. You should free the * returned string with g_free() when done. * * Since: 2.12 */ gchar * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_text (GtkWidget *widget) { gchar *text = NULL; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); g_object_get (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-text", &text, NULL); return text; } /** * gtk_widget_set_tooltip_markup: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @markup: (allow-none): the contents of the tooltip for @widget, or %NULL * * Sets @markup as the contents of the tooltip, which is marked up with * the Pango text markup language. * * This function will take care of setting #GtkWidget:has-tooltip to %TRUE * and of the default handler for the #GtkWidget::query-tooltip signal. * * See also the #GtkWidget:tooltip-markup property and * gtk_tooltip_set_markup(). * * Since: 2.12 */ void gtk_widget_set_tooltip_markup (GtkWidget *widget, const gchar *markup) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_object_set (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-markup", markup, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_markup: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Gets the contents of the tooltip for @widget. * * Return value: the tooltip text, or %NULL. You should free the * returned string with g_free() when done. * * Since: 2.12 */ gchar * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_markup (GtkWidget *widget) { gchar *text = NULL; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); g_object_get (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-markup", &text, NULL); return text; } /** * gtk_widget_set_has_tooltip: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @has_tooltip: whether or not @widget has a tooltip. * * Sets the has-tooltip property on @widget to @has_tooltip. See * #GtkWidget:has-tooltip for more information. * * Since: 2.12 */ void gtk_widget_set_has_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean has_tooltip) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_object_set (G_OBJECT (widget), "has-tooltip", has_tooltip, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_get_has_tooltip: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the current value of the has-tooltip property. See * #GtkWidget:has-tooltip for more information. * * Return value: current value of has-tooltip on @widget. * * Since: 2.12 */ gboolean gtk_widget_get_has_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget) { gboolean has_tooltip = FALSE; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_object_get (G_OBJECT (widget), "has-tooltip", &has_tooltip, NULL); return has_tooltip; } /** * gtk_widget_get_allocation: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @allocation: (out): a pointer to a #GtkAllocation to copy to * * Retrieves the widget's allocation. * * Note, when implementing a #GtkContainer: a widget's allocation will * be its "adjusted" allocation, that is, the widget's parent * container typically calls gtk_widget_size_allocate() with an * allocation, and that allocation is then adjusted (to handle margin * and alignment for example) before assignment to the widget. * gtk_widget_get_allocation() returns the adjusted allocation that * was actually assigned to the widget. The adjusted allocation is * guaranteed to be completely contained within the * gtk_widget_size_allocate() allocation, however. So a #GtkContainer * is guaranteed that its children stay inside the assigned bounds, * but not that they have exactly the bounds the container assigned. * There is no way to get the original allocation assigned by * gtk_widget_size_allocate(), since it isn't stored; if a container * implementation needs that information it will have to track it itself. * * Since: 2.18 */ void gtk_widget_get_allocation (GtkWidget *widget, GtkAllocation *allocation) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (allocation != NULL); priv = widget->priv; *allocation = priv->allocation; } /** * gtk_widget_set_allocation: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @allocation: a pointer to a #GtkAllocation to copy from * * Sets the widget's allocation. This should not be used * directly, but from within a widget's size_allocate method. * * The allocation set should be the "adjusted" or actual * allocation. If you're implementing a #GtkContainer, you want to use * gtk_widget_size_allocate() instead of gtk_widget_set_allocation(). * The GtkWidgetClass::adjust_size_allocation virtual method adjusts the * allocation inside gtk_widget_size_allocate() to create an adjusted * allocation. * * Since: 2.18 */ void gtk_widget_set_allocation (GtkWidget *widget, const GtkAllocation *allocation) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (allocation != NULL); priv = widget->priv; priv->allocation = *allocation; } /** * gtk_widget_get_allocated_width: * @widget: the widget to query * * Returns the width that has currently been allocated to @widget. * This function is intended to be used when implementing handlers * for the #GtkWidget::draw function. * * Returns: the width of the @widget **/ int gtk_widget_get_allocated_width (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return widget->priv->allocation.width; } /** * gtk_widget_get_allocated_height: * @widget: the widget to query * * Returns the height that has currently been allocated to @widget. * This function is intended to be used when implementing handlers * for the #GtkWidget::draw function. * * Returns: the height of the @widget **/ int gtk_widget_get_allocated_height (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); return widget->priv->allocation.height; } /** * gtk_widget_get_requisition: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @requisition: (out): a pointer to a #GtkRequisition to copy to * * Retrieves the widget's requisition. * * This function should only be used by widget implementations in * order to figure whether the widget's requisition has actually * changed after some internal state change (so that they can call * gtk_widget_queue_resize() instead of gtk_widget_queue_draw()). * * Normally, gtk_widget_size_request() should be used. * * Since: 2.20 * * Deprecated: 3.0: The #GtkRequisition cache on the widget was * removed, If you need to cache sizes across requests and allocations, * add an explicit cache to the widget in question instead. */ void gtk_widget_get_requisition (GtkWidget *widget, GtkRequisition *requisition) { g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (requisition != NULL); gtk_widget_get_preferred_size (widget, requisition, NULL); } /** * gtk_widget_set_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @window: a #GdkWindow * * Sets a widget's window. This function should only be used in a * widget's #GtkWidget::realize implementation. The %window passed is * usually either new window created with gdk_window_new(), or the * window of its parent widget as returned by * gtk_widget_get_parent_window(). * * Widgets must indicate whether they will create their own #GdkWindow * by calling gtk_widget_set_has_window(). This is usually done in the * widget's init() function. * * This function does not add any reference to @window. * * Since: 2.18 */ void gtk_widget_set_window (GtkWidget *widget, GdkWindow *window) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); g_return_if_fail (window == NULL || GDK_IS_WINDOW (window)); priv = widget->priv; if (priv->window != window) { priv->window = window; g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "window"); } } /** * gtk_widget_get_window: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the widget's window if it is realized, %NULL otherwise * * Return value: (transfer none): @widget's window. * * Since: 2.14 */ GdkWindow* gtk_widget_get_window (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); return widget->priv->window; } /** * gtk_widget_get_support_multidevice: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns %TRUE if @widget is multiple pointer aware. See * gtk_widget_set_support_multidevice() for more information. * * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is multidevice aware. **/ gboolean gtk_widget_get_support_multidevice (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); return widget->priv->multidevice; } /** * gtk_widget_set_support_multidevice: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @support_multidevice: %TRUE to support input from multiple devices. * * Enables or disables multiple pointer awareness. If this setting is %TRUE, * @widget will start receiving multiple, per device enter/leave events. Note * that if custom #GdkWindows are created in #GtkWidget::realize, * gdk_window_set_support_multidevice() will have to be called manually on them. * * Since: 3.0 **/ void gtk_widget_set_support_multidevice (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean support_multidevice) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); priv = widget->priv; priv->multidevice = (support_multidevice == TRUE); if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) gdk_window_set_support_multidevice (priv->window, support_multidevice); } static void _gtk_widget_set_has_focus (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean has_focus) { widget->priv->has_focus = has_focus; if (has_focus) gtk_widget_set_state_flags (widget, GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED, FALSE); else gtk_widget_unset_state_flags (widget, GTK_STATE_FLAG_FOCUSED); } /** * gtk_widget_send_focus_change: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * @event: a #GdkEvent of type GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE * * Sends the focus change @event to @widget * * This function is not meant to be used by applications. The only time it * should be used is when it is necessary for a #GtkWidget to assign focus * to a widget that is semantically owned by the first widget even though * it's not a direct child - for instance, a search entry in a floating * window similar to the quick search in #GtkTreeView. * * An example of its usage is: * * |[ * GdkEvent *fevent = gdk_event_new (GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE); * * fevent->focus_change.type = GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE; * fevent->focus_change.in = TRUE; * fevent->focus_change.window = gtk_widget_get_window (widget); * if (fevent->focus_change.window != NULL) * g_object_ref (fevent->focus_change.window); * * gtk_widget_send_focus_change (widget, fevent); * * gdk_event_free (event); * ]| * * Return value: the return value from the event signal emission: %TRUE * if the event was handled, and %FALSE otherwise * * Since: 2.20 */ gboolean gtk_widget_send_focus_change (GtkWidget *widget, GdkEvent *event) { gboolean res; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); g_return_val_if_fail (event != NULL && event->type == GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE, FALSE); g_object_ref (widget); _gtk_widget_set_has_focus (widget, event->focus_change.in); res = gtk_widget_event (widget, event); g_object_notify (G_OBJECT (widget), "has-focus"); g_object_unref (widget); return res; } /** * gtk_widget_in_destruction: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns whether the widget is currently being destroyed. * This information can sometimes be used to avoid doing * unnecessary work. * * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is being destroyed */ gboolean gtk_widget_in_destruction (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->in_destruction; } gboolean _gtk_widget_get_resize_pending (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->resize_pending; } void _gtk_widget_set_resize_pending (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean resize_pending) { widget->priv->resize_pending = resize_pending; } gboolean _gtk_widget_get_in_reparent (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->in_reparent; } void _gtk_widget_set_in_reparent (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean in_reparent) { widget->priv->in_reparent = in_reparent; } gboolean _gtk_widget_get_anchored (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->anchored; } void _gtk_widget_set_anchored (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean anchored) { widget->priv->anchored = anchored; } gboolean _gtk_widget_get_shadowed (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->shadowed; } void _gtk_widget_set_shadowed (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean shadowed) { widget->priv->shadowed = shadowed; } gboolean _gtk_widget_get_alloc_needed (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->alloc_needed; } void _gtk_widget_set_alloc_needed (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean alloc_needed) { widget->priv->alloc_needed = alloc_needed; } gboolean _gtk_widget_get_width_request_needed (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->width_request_needed; } void _gtk_widget_set_width_request_needed (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean width_request_needed) { widget->priv->width_request_needed = width_request_needed; } gboolean _gtk_widget_get_height_request_needed (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->height_request_needed; } void _gtk_widget_set_height_request_needed (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean height_request_needed) { widget->priv->height_request_needed = height_request_needed; } gboolean _gtk_widget_get_sizegroup_visited (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->sizegroup_visited; } void _gtk_widget_set_sizegroup_visited (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean visited) { widget->priv->sizegroup_visited = visited; } gboolean _gtk_widget_get_sizegroup_bumping (GtkWidget *widget) { return widget->priv->sizegroup_bumping; } void _gtk_widget_set_sizegroup_bumping (GtkWidget *widget, gboolean bumping) { widget->priv->sizegroup_bumping = bumping; } void _gtk_widget_add_sizegroup (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer group) { GSList *groups; groups = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups); groups = g_slist_prepend (groups, group); g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups, groups); widget->priv->have_size_groups = TRUE; } void _gtk_widget_remove_sizegroup (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer group) { GSList *groups; groups = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups); groups = g_slist_remove (groups, group); g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups, groups); widget->priv->have_size_groups = groups != NULL; } GSList * _gtk_widget_get_sizegroups (GtkWidget *widget) { if (widget->priv->have_size_groups) return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups); return NULL; } /** * gtk_widget_get_path: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the #GtkWidgetPath representing @widget, if the widget * is not connected to a toplevel widget, a partial path will be * created. * * Returns: (transfer none): The #GtkWidgetPath representing @widget **/ GtkWidgetPath * gtk_widget_get_path (GtkWidget *widget) { g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); /* As strange as it may seem, this may happen on object construction. * init() implementations of parent types may eventually call this function, * each with its corresponding GType, which could leave a child * implementation with a wrong widget type in the widget path */ if (widget->priv->path && G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget) != gtk_widget_path_get_object_type (widget->priv->path)) { gtk_widget_path_free (widget->priv->path); widget->priv->path = NULL; } if (!widget->priv->path) { GtkWidget *parent; guint pos; parent = widget->priv->parent; if (parent) widget->priv->path = gtk_container_get_path_for_child (GTK_CONTAINER (parent), widget); else { /* Widget is either toplevel or unparented, treat both * as toplevels style wise, since there are situations * where style properties might be retrieved on that * situation. */ widget->priv->path = gtk_widget_path_new (); } pos = gtk_widget_path_append_type (widget->priv->path, G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget)); if (widget->priv->name) gtk_widget_path_iter_set_name (widget->priv->path, pos, widget->priv->name); if (widget->priv->context) { GList *classes, *l; /* Also add any persistent classes in * the style context the widget path */ classes = gtk_style_context_list_classes (widget->priv->context); for (l = classes; l; l = l->next) gtk_widget_path_iter_add_class (widget->priv->path, pos, l->data); gtk_style_context_set_path (widget->priv->context, widget->priv->path); g_list_free (classes); } } return widget->priv->path; } static void style_context_changed (GtkStyleContext *context, gpointer user_data) { GtkWidget *widget = user_data; gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget); if (gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[STYLE_UPDATED], 0); else { /* Compress all style updates so it * is only emitted once pre-realize. */ widget->priv->style_update_pending = TRUE; } if (widget->priv->anchored) gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); } /** * gtk_widget_get_style_context: * @widget: a #GtkWidget * * Returns the style context associated to @widget. * * Returns: (transfer none): a #GtkStyleContext. This memory is owned by @widget and * must not be freed. **/ GtkStyleContext * gtk_widget_get_style_context (GtkWidget *widget) { GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; GtkWidgetPath *path; g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); priv = widget->priv; /* updates style context if it exists already */ path = gtk_widget_get_path (widget); if (G_UNLIKELY (priv->context == NULL)) { GdkScreen *screen; priv->context = g_object_new (GTK_TYPE_STYLE_CONTEXT, "direction", gtk_widget_get_direction (widget), NULL); g_signal_connect (widget->priv->context, "changed", G_CALLBACK (style_context_changed), widget); screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (widget); if (screen) gtk_style_context_set_screen (priv->context, screen); gtk_style_context_set_path (priv->context, path); } return widget->priv->context; }